Merge from gnus--devo--0
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
CommitLineData
4009494e
GM
1\input texinfo
2
db78a8cb 3@setfilename ../../info/gnus
4009494e
GM
4@settitle Gnus Manual
5@syncodeindex fn cp
6@syncodeindex vr cp
7@syncodeindex pg cp
8
01c52d31
MB
9@documentencoding ISO-8859-1
10
4009494e 11@copying
e3e955fe
MB
12Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
132003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4009494e
GM
14
15@quotation
16Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
6a2c4aec 17under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
4009494e 18any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
debf4439
GM
19Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
20and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
21is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
4009494e 22
6f093307
GM
23(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
24modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
25developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
4009494e
GM
26@end quotation
27@end copying
28
29@iftex
30@iflatex
31\documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
32\usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
33\usepackage{pagestyle}
34\usepackage{epsfig}
35\usepackage{pixidx}
36\input{gnusconfig.tex}
37
38\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
39\else
40\usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
41\usepackage{thumbpdf}
42\pdfcompresslevel=9
43\fi
44
45\makeindex
46\begin{document}
47
48% Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 49\newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
4009494e
GM
50\newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
51\newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
52
53\newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
54
55\newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
56\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
57\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58\else
59\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
60\fi
61\newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62\newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63
64\newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65\newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66
67\newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
68\newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69\newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70\newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71\newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72\newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73\newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
74\newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75\newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76\newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77\newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78\newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79\newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80\newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
81\newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
82\newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83\newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
84\newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
85\newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
86\newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
87\newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
88\newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
89\newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
90\newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
91
92\newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
93\newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
94\newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
95\newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
96\newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
97\newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
98\newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
99\newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
100\newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
101\newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
102\newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
103\newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
104\newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
105
106\newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
107\newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
108\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
109}
110
111\newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
112
113\newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
114{\mbox{}}
115}
116
117\newdimen{\gnusdimen}
118\gnusdimen 0pt
119
120\newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
121\gnuscleardoublepage
122\ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
123\chapter{#2}
124\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
125\renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
126\thispagestyle{empty}
127\hspace*{-2cm}
128\begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
129\put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
130\put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
131\end{picture}
132\clearpage
133}
134
135\newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
136\begin{figure}
137\mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
138#3
139\end{picture}
140\caption{#1}
141\end{figure}
142}
143
144\newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
145\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
146}
147
148\newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
149\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
150}
151
152\newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
153\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
154}
155
156\newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
157\margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
158}
159
160\newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
161
162\newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
163\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
164\section{#1}
165}
166
167\newenvironment{codelist}%
168{\begin{list}{}{
169}
170}{\end{list}}
171
172\newenvironment{asislist}%
173{\begin{list}{}{
174}
175}{\end{list}}
176
177\newenvironment{kbdlist}%
178{\begin{list}{}{
179\labelwidth=0cm
180}
181}{\end{list}}
182
183\newenvironment{dfnlist}%
184{\begin{list}{}{
185}
186}{\end{list}}
187
188\newenvironment{stronglist}%
189{\begin{list}{}{
190}
191}{\end{list}}
192
193\newenvironment{samplist}%
194{\begin{list}{}{
195}
196}{\end{list}}
197
198\newenvironment{varlist}%
199{\begin{list}{}{
200}
201}{\end{list}}
202
203\newenvironment{emphlist}%
204{\begin{list}{}{
205}
206}{\end{list}}
207
208\newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
209\setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
210\addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
211
212\newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
213{
214{
215\ifodd\count0
216{
217\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
218}
219\else
220{
221\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
222}
223}
224\fi
225}
226}
227{
228\ifodd\count0
229\mbox{} \hfill
230\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
231\else
232\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
233\hfill \mbox{}
234\fi
235}
236
237\newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
238{
239{
240\ifodd\count0
241{
242\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
243}
244\else
245{
246\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
247}
248\fi
249}
250}
251{
252\ifodd\count0
253\mbox{} \hfill
254\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
255\else
256\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
257\hfill \mbox{}
258\fi
259}
260
261\newpagestyle{gnus}%
262{
263{
264\ifodd\count0
265{
266\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
267}
268\else
269{
270\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
271}
272\fi
273}
274}
275{
276\ifodd\count0
277\mbox{} \hfill
278\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
279\else
280\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
281\hfill \mbox{}
282\fi
283}
284
285\pagenumbering{roman}
286\pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
287
288@end iflatex
289@end iftex
290
291@iftex
292@iflatex
293
294\begin{titlepage}
295{
296
297%\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
298%\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
299\parindent=0cm
300\addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
301
302\gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
303\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
304\vfill
305\hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
306\vfill
307\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308\gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
309\newpage
310}
311
312\mbox{}
313\vfill
314
315\thispagestyle{empty}
316
317@c @insertcopying
318\newpage
319\end{titlepage}
320@end iflatex
321@end iftex
322
323@ifnottex
324@insertcopying
325@end ifnottex
326
327@dircategory Emacs
328@direntry
329* Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
330@end direntry
331@iftex
332@finalout
333@end iftex
334@setchapternewpage odd
335
336
337
338@titlepage
339@title Gnus Manual
340
341@author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
342@page
343@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
344@insertcopying
345@end titlepage
346
347
348@node Top
349@top The Gnus Newsreader
350
351@ifinfo
352
353You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
354can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
355spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
356luck.
357
358@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 359This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
4009494e
GM
360
361@end ifinfo
362
363@iftex
364
365@iflatex
366\tableofcontents
367\gnuscleardoublepage
368@end iflatex
369
370Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
371unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
372
373Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
374being accused of plagiarism:
375
376Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
377about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
378you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
379can even read news with it!
380
381Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
382people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
383allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
384like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
385people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
386the program.
387
9b3ebcb6 388@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
2e4089ab 389This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
9b3ebcb6
MB
390
391@heading Other related manuals
392@itemize
393@item Message manual: Composing messages
394@item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
395@item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
396@item PGG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
2e4089ab 397@item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
9b3ebcb6
MB
398@end itemize
399
4009494e
GM
400@end iftex
401
402@menu
403* Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
404* Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
405* Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
406* Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
407* Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
408* Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
409* Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
410* Various:: General purpose settings.
411* The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
412* Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
413* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
414* Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
415* Key Index:: Key Index.
416
417Other related manuals
418
419* Message:(message). Composing messages.
420* Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
421* Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
422* PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
01c52d31 423* SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
4009494e
GM
424
425@detailmenu
426 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
427
428Starting Gnus
429
430* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
431* The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
432* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
433* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
434* Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
435* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
436* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
437* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
438* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
439* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
440* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
441
442New Groups
443
444* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
445* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
446* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
447
448Group Buffer
449
450* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
451* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
452* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
453* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
454* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
455* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
456* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
457* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
458* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
459* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
460* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
461* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
462* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
463* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
464* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
465* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 466* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
4009494e
GM
467* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
468
469Group Buffer Format
470
471* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
472* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
473* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
474
475Group Topics
476
477* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
478* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
479* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
480* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
481* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
482
483Misc Group Stuff
484
485* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
486* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
487* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
488* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
489* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
490
491Summary Buffer
492
493* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
494* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
495* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
496* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
497* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
498* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
499* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
500* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
501* Threading:: How threads are made.
502* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
503* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
504* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
505* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
01c52d31 506* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4009494e
GM
507* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
508* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
509* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
510* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
511* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
512* Charsets:: Character set issues.
513* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
514* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
515* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
516* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
517* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
518* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
519* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
520* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
521 or reselecting the current group.
522* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
523* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
524* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
525* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
526
527Summary Buffer Format
528
529* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
530* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
531* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
532* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
533
534Choosing Articles
535
536* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
537* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
538
539Reply, Followup and Post
540
541* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
542* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
543* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
544* Canceling and Superseding::
545
546Marking Articles
547
548* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
549* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
550* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
551* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
552* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
553* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
554
555Threading
556
557* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
558* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
559
560Customizing Threading
561
562* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
563* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
564* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
565* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
566
567Decoding Articles
568
569* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
570* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
571* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
572* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
573* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
574* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
575
576Decoding Variables
577
578* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
579* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
580* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
581
582Article Treatment
583
584* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
585* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
586* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
587* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
588* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
589* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
590* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
591* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
592* Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
593* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
594* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
595
596Alternative Approaches
597
598* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
599* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
600
601Various Summary Stuff
602
603* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
604* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
605* Summary Generation Commands::
606* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
607
608Article Buffer
609
610* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
611* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
612* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
613* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
614* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
615
616Composing Messages
617
618* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
619* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
620* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
621* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
622* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
623* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
624* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
625* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
626* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
627
628Select Methods
629
630* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
631* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
632* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
633* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
634* IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
635* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
636* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
637* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
638* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
639
640Server Buffer
641
642* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
643* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
644* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
645* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
646* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
647* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
648* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
649
650Getting News
651
652* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
653* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
654
655@acronym{NNTP}
656
657* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
658* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
659* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
01c52d31 660* NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
4009494e
GM
661
662Getting Mail
663
664* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
665* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
666* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
667* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
668* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
669* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
670* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
671* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
672* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
673* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
674* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
675* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
676* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
677
678Mail Sources
679
680* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
681* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
682* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
683
684Choosing a Mail Back End
685
686* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
687* Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
688* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
689* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
690* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
691* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
692* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
693
694Browsing the Web
695
696* Archiving Mail::
697* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
698* Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
699* Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
700* Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
701* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
702* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
703
704@acronym{IMAP}
705
706* Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
707* Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
708* Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
709* Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
710* A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
711* Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
712
713Other Sources
714
715* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
716* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
717* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
718* SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
719* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
720
721Document Groups
722
723* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
724
725SOUP
726
727* SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
728* SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
729* SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
730
731Combined Groups
732
733* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
734* Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
735
736Email Based Diary
737
738* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
739* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
740* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
741
742The NNDiary Back End
743
744* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
745* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
746* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
747
748The Gnus Diary Library
749
750* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
751* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
752* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
753* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
754
755Gnus Unplugged
756
757* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
758* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
759* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
760* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
761* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
762* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
763* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
01c52d31 764* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
4009494e
GM
765* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
766* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
767* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
768* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
769* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
770* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
771
772Agent Categories
773
774* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
775* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
776* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
777
778Agent Commands
779
780* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
781* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
782* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
783
784Scoring
785
786* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
787* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
788* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
789* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
790* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
791* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
792* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
793* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
794* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
795* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
796* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
797* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
798* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
799* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
4009494e
GM
800* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
801* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
802
4009494e
GM
803Advanced Scoring
804
805* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
806* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
807* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
808
809Various
810
811* Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
812* Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
813* Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
814* Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
815* Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
816* Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
817* Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
818* Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
819* Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
820* Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
821* Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
822* NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
823* Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
824* Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
825* Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
826* Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
827* Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
828* Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
829* Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
64763fe3 830* The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
4009494e
GM
831* Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
832* Various Various:: Things that are really various.
833
834Formatting Variables
835
836* Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
837* Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
838* Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
839* User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
840* Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
841* Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
842* Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
843* Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
844
845Image Enhancements
846
847* X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
848* Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
849* Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
850 meant to be shown.
851* Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
852* XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
853
854Thwarting Email Spam
855
856* The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
857* Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
858* SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
859* Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
860
861Spam Package
862
863* Spam Package Introduction::
864* Filtering Incoming Mail::
865* Detecting Spam in Groups::
866* Spam and Ham Processors::
867* Spam Package Configuration Examples::
868* Spam Back Ends::
869* Extending the Spam package::
870* Spam Statistics Package::
871
872Spam Statistics Package
873
874* Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
875* Splitting mail using spam-stat::
876* Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
877
878Appendices
879
880* XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
881* History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
882* On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
883* Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
884* Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
885* Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
886* Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
887* Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
888* Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
889
890History
891
892* Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
893* Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
894* Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
895* Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
896* Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
897* Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
898* Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
899* Contributors:: Oodles of people.
900* New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
901
902New Features
903
904* ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
905* September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
906* Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
907* Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
908* Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
909* Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
01c52d31 910* No Gnus:: Very punny.
4009494e
GM
911
912Customization
913
914* Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
915* Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
916* Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
917* Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
918
919Gnus Reference Guide
920
921* Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
922* Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
923* Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
924* Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
925* Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
926* Group Info:: The group info format.
927* Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
928* Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
929* Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
930
931Back End Interface
932
933* Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
934* Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
935* Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
936* Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
937* Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
938* Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
939
940Various File Formats
941
942* Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
943* Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
944
945Emacs for Heathens
946
947* Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
948* Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
949
950@end detailmenu
951@end menu
952
953@node Starting Up
954@chapter Starting Gnus
955@cindex starting up
956
957If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
958Heathens} first.
959
960@kindex M-x gnus
961@findex gnus
962If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
963and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
964your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
965@code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
966minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
967@code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
968
969@findex gnus-other-frame
970@kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
971If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
972@kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
973
974If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
975variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
976@file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
977
978If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
979terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
980
981@menu
982* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
983* The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
984* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
985* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
986* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
987* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
988* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
989* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
990* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
991* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
992@end menu
993
994
995@node Finding the News
996@section Finding the News
997@cindex finding news
998
999@vindex gnus-select-method
1000@c @head
1001The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1002news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1003@dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1004native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1005foreign groups.
1006
1007For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1008you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1009
1010@lisp
1011(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1012@end lisp
1013
1014If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1015
1016@lisp
1017(setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1018@end lisp
1019
1020If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1021certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1022server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1023server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1024
1025@vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1026@cindex NNTPSERVER
1027@cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1028If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1029@env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1030Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1031(@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1032If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1033as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1034
1035@vindex gnus-nntp-server
1036If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1037@code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1038@code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1039
1040@vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1041@vindex gnus-nntp-server
1042You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1043@acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1044(i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1045in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1046type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1047will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1048gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1049server.)
1050
1051@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1052@kindex B (Group)
1053However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1054interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1055better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1056let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1057to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1058maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1059
1060@vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1061@c @head
1062A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1063@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1064listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1065@code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1066files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1067appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1068groups are.
1069
1070For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1071you would typically set this variable to
1072
1073@lisp
1074(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1075@end lisp
1076
01c52d31
MB
1077Note: the @acronym{NNTP} back end stores marks in marks files
1078(@pxref{NNTP marks}). This feature makes it easy to share marks between
1079several Gnus installations, but may slow down things a bit when fetching
1080new articles. @xref{NNTP marks}, for more information.
1081
4009494e
GM
1082
1083@node The First Time
1084@section The First Time
1085@cindex first time usage
1086
1087If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1088determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1089
1090@vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1091If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1092will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1093killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1094something useful.
1095
1096Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1097picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1098here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1099
1100You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1101help you with most common problems.
1102
1103If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1104use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1105special.
1106
1107
1108@node The Server is Down
1109@section The Server is Down
1110@cindex server errors
1111
1112If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1113problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1114the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1115
1116Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1117without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1118will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1119given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1120for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1121groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1122buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1123
1124@findex gnus-no-server
1125@kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1126@c @head
1127If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1128your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1129@code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1130if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1131your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
11321 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1133levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1134
1135
1136@node Slave Gnusae
1137@section Slave Gnusae
1138@cindex slave
1139
1140You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1141same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1142are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1143that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1144
1145The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1146@file{.newsrc} file.
1147
1148To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1149Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1150@dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1151taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1152conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1153me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1154Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1155
1156@findex gnus-slave
1157Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1158however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1159@kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1160files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1161on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1162starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1163information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1164they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1165
1166Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1167information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1168
1169If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1170slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1171file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1172incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1173messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1174
1175
1176
1177@node New Groups
1178@section New Groups
1179@cindex new groups
1180@cindex subscription
1181
1182@vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1183If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1184you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1185also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1186@code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1187@kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1188is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1189@code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1190when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1191
1192@menu
1193* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1194* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1195* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1196@end menu
1197
1198
1199@node Checking New Groups
1200@subsection Checking New Groups
1201
1202Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1203list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1204dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1205@code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1206server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1207cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1208groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1209@code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1210Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1211Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1212
1213I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1214server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1215fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1216@code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1217few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1218work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1219supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1220You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1221whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1222it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1223@samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1224
1225This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1226issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1227subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1228if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1229that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1230Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1231
1232
1233@node Subscription Methods
1234@subsection Subscription Methods
1235
1236@vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1237What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1238@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1239
1240This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1241with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1242
1243Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1244
1245@table @code
1246
1247@item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1248@vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1249Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1250zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1251(with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1252
1253@item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1254@vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1255Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1256new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1257
1258@item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1259@vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1260Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1261
1262@item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1263@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1264Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1265function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1266@code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1267alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1268hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1269@samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1270up. Or something like that.
1271
1272@item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1273@vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1274Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1275you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1276to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1277
1278@item gnus-subscribe-killed
1279@vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1280Kill all new groups.
1281
1282@item gnus-subscribe-topics
1283@vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1284Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1285parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1286topic parameter that looks like
1287
1288@example
1289"nnslashdot"
1290@end example
1291
1292will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1293that topic.
1294
1295If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1296top-level topic.
1297
1298@end table
1299
1300@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1301A closely related variable is
1302@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1303mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1304hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1305will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1306hierarchy or not.
1307
1308One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1309(@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1310@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1311will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1312
1313
1314@node Filtering New Groups
1315@subsection Filtering New Groups
1316
1317A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1318subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1319the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1320
1321@example
1322options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1323@end example
1324
1325@vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1326This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1327person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1328groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1329be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1330be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1331subscribing these groups.
1332@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1333variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1334
1335@vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1336@vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1337If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1338set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1339@code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1340same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1341and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1342subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1343
1344@vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1345Yet another variable that meddles here is
1346@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1347@code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1348but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1349more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1350used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1351groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1352@code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1353subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1354@code{nil}.
1355
1356New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1357@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1358
1359
1360@node Changing Servers
1361@section Changing Servers
1362@cindex changing servers
1363
1364Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1365This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1366very flaky and you want to use another.
1367
1368Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1369@code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1370
1371@emph{Wrong!}
1372
1373Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1374@acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1375you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1376change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1377worthless.
1378
1379Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1380file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1381common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1382functions more than absolutely necessary.
1383
1384@kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1385@findex gnus-change-server
1386If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1387the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1388article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1389gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1390will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1391
1392@kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1393@findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1394You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1395gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1396move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1397
1398@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1399@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1400If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1401and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1402gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1403that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1404
1405@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1406@findex gnus-group-clear-data
1407Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1408list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1409
1410After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1411since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1412affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1413@code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1414to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1415can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1416cache for all groups).
1417
1418
1419@node Startup Files
1420@section Startup Files
1421@cindex startup files
1422@cindex .newsrc
1423@cindex .newsrc.el
1424@cindex .newsrc.eld
1425
1426Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1427@file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1428groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1429read.
1430
1431Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1432keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1433@file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1434the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1435the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1436files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1437@sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1438
1439That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1440@file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1441@file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1442recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1443never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1444not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1445
1446@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1447@vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1448You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1449@code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1450the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1451However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1452Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1453@code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1454@file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1455convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1456want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1457news reader.
1458
1459@vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1460If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1461will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1462save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1463will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1464so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1465You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1466@code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1467Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1468the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1469saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1470several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1471
1472@vindex gnus-startup-file
1473@vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1474@vindex version-control
1475The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1476The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1477file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1478If you want version control for this file, set
1479@code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1480@code{version-control} variable.
1481
1482@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1483@vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1484@vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1485@code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1486files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1487saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1488@code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1489@file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1490control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1491startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1492
1493@lisp
1494(defun turn-off-backup ()
1495 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1496
1497(add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1498(add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1499@end lisp
1500
1501@vindex gnus-init-file
1502@vindex gnus-site-init-file
1503When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1504(@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1505(@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1506and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1507@file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1508with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1509suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1510@file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1511and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1512the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1513Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1514@code{gnus-init-file}.
1515
1516
1517@node Auto Save
1518@section Auto Save
1519@cindex dribble file
1520@cindex auto-save
1521
1522Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1523catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1524special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1525Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1526@file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1527this file.
1528
1529If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1530read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1531saved.
1532
1533@vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1534If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1535maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1536
1537@vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1538Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1539this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1540into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1541normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1542file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1543
1544@vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1545If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1546read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1547
1548
1549@node The Active File
1550@section The Active File
1551@cindex active file
1552@cindex ignored groups
1553
1554When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1555articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1556file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1557
1558@vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1559Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1560regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1561any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1562ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1563recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1564Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1565
1566@c This variable is
1567@c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1568@c if you set it to anything else.
1569
1570@vindex gnus-read-active-file
1571@c @head
1572The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1573can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1574reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1575
1576Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1577you actually subscribe to.
1578
1579Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1580variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1581present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1582considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1583
1584This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1585attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1586servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1587support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1588at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1589is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1590
1591Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1592instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1593servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1594variable.
1595
1596If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1597lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1598@acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1599read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1600performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1601@code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1602
1603If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1604different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1605
1606In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1607kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1608
1609Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1610secondary select methods.
1611
1612
1613@node Startup Variables
1614@section Startup Variables
1615
1616@table @code
1617
1618@item gnus-load-hook
1619@vindex gnus-load-hook
1620A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1621normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1622times you start Gnus.
1623
1624@item gnus-before-startup-hook
1625@vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
e3e955fe 1626A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
4009494e
GM
1627
1628@item gnus-startup-hook
1629@vindex gnus-startup-hook
1630A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1631
1632@item gnus-started-hook
1633@vindex gnus-started-hook
1634A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1635successfully.
1636
1637@item gnus-setup-news-hook
1638@vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1639A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1640generating the group buffer.
1641
1642@item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1643@vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1644If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1645startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1646@file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1647bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1648best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1649in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1650
1651@item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1652@vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1653If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1654your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1655of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1656@file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1657
1658@item gnus-no-groups-message
1659@vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1660Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1661
1662@item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1663@vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1664If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1665
1666@item gnus-startup-jingle
1667@vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1668Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1669default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1670
1671@end table
1672
1673
1674@node Group Buffer
1675@chapter Group Buffer
1676@cindex group buffer
1677
1678@c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1679@c
1680@c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1681@c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1682@c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1683@c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1684@c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1685@c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1686@c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1687@c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1688@c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1689@c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1690@c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1691@c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1692@c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1693@c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1694@c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1695@c human rights at 9...
1696
1697
1698The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1699is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1700long as Gnus is active.
1701
1702@iftex
1703@iflatex
1704\gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1705\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1706\put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1707\put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1708\put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1709\put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1710\put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1711\put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1712}
1713@end iflatex
1714@end iftex
1715
1716@menu
1717* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1718* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1719* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1720* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1721* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1722* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1723* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1724* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1725* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1726* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1727* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1728* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1729* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1730* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1731* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1732* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 1733* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
e6d2d263 1734* Searching:: Mail search engines.
4009494e
GM
1735* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1736@end menu
1737
1738
1739@node Group Buffer Format
1740@section Group Buffer Format
1741
1742@menu
1743* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1744* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1745* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1746@end menu
1747
1748You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1749customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1750available in Emacs.
1751
1752The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1753cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1754slower. You can disable this via the variable
1755@code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1756Emacs version.
1757
1758@node Group Line Specification
1759@subsection Group Line Specification
1760@cindex group buffer format
1761
1762The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1763make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1764
1765Here's a couple of example group lines:
1766
1767@example
1768 25: news.announce.newusers
1769 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1770@end example
1771
1772Quite simple, huh?
1773
1774You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1775@samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1776ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1777asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1778
1779@vindex gnus-group-line-format
1780You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1781@code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1782lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1783a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1784@xref{Formatting Variables}.
1785
1786@samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1787
1788There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1789the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1790Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1791displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1792Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1793
1794(Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1795layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1796instead of wasting time reading news.)
1797
1798Here's a list of all available format characters:
1799
1800@table @samp
1801
1802@item M
1803An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1804
1805@item S
1806Whether the group is subscribed.
1807
1808@item L
1809Level of subscribedness.
1810
1811@item N
1812Number of unread articles.
1813
1814@item I
1815Number of dormant articles.
1816
1817@item T
1818Number of ticked articles.
1819
1820@item R
1821Number of read articles.
1822
1823@item U
1824Number of unseen articles.
1825
1826@item t
1827Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1828minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1829
1830Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1831efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1832the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1833hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1834unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1835interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
01c52d31
MB
1836end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1837
1838The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1839compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1840renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1841getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1842future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1843date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1844server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
4009494e
GM
1845
1846@item y
1847Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1848
1849@item i
1850Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1851
1852@item g
1853Full group name.
1854
1855@item G
1856Group name.
1857
1858@item C
1859Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1860comment element in the group parameters.
1861
1862@item D
1863Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1864before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1865@code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1866command.
1867
1868@item o
1869@samp{m} if moderated.
1870
1871@item O
1872@samp{(m)} if moderated.
1873
1874@item s
1875Select method.
1876
1877@item B
1878If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1879
1880@item n
1881Select from where.
1882
1883@item z
1884A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1885used.
1886
1887@item P
1888Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1889
1890@item c
1891@vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1892Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1893variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1894The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1895@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1896
1897@item m
1898@vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1899@cindex %
1900@samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1901the group lately.
1902
1903@item p
1904@samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1905
1906@item d
1907A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1908Timestamp}).
1909
01c52d31
MB
1910@item F
1911The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1912agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1913megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1914of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1915
4009494e
GM
1916@item u
1917User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1918be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1919@code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1920following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1921parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1922be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1923specifier.
1924@end table
1925
1926@cindex *
1927All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1928if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1929group, or a bogus native group.
1930
1931
1932@node Group Mode Line Specification
1933@subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1934@cindex group mode line
1935
1936@vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1937The mode line can be changed by setting
1938@code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1939doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1940
1941@table @samp
1942@item S
1943The native news server.
1944@item M
1945The native select method.
1946@end table
1947
1948
1949@node Group Highlighting
1950@subsection Group Highlighting
1951@cindex highlighting
1952@cindex group highlighting
1953
1954@vindex gnus-group-highlight
1955Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1956@code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1957that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1958something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1959
1960Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1961background is dark:
1962
1963@lisp
1964(cond (window-system
1965 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1966 (defface my-group-face-1
1967 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1968 (defface my-group-face-2
1969 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1970 "Second group face")
1971 (defface my-group-face-3
1972 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1973 (defface my-group-face-4
1974 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1975 (defface my-group-face-5
1976 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1977
1978(setq gnus-group-highlight
1979 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1980 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1981 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1982 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1983 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1984@end lisp
1985
1986Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1987
1988Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1989include:
1990
1991@table @code
1992@item group
1993The group name.
1994@item unread
1995The number of unread articles in the group.
1996@item method
1997The select method.
1998@item mailp
1999Whether the group is a mail group.
2000@item level
2001The level of the group.
2002@item score
2003The score of the group.
2004@item ticked
2005The number of ticked articles in the group.
2006@item total
2007The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
2008@var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
2009@item topic
2010When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
2011topic being inserted.
2012@end table
2013
2014When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
2015of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
2016functions for snarfing info on the group.
2017
2018@vindex gnus-group-update-hook
2019@findex gnus-group-highlight-line
2020@code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
2021It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
2022calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
2023
2024
2025@node Group Maneuvering
2026@section Group Maneuvering
2027@cindex group movement
2028
2029All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
2030expected, hopefully.
2031
2032@table @kbd
2033
2034@item n
2035@kindex n (Group)
2036@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
2037Go to the next group that has unread articles
2038(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
2039
2040@item p
2041@itemx DEL
2042@kindex DEL (Group)
2043@kindex p (Group)
2044@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2045Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2046(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2047
2048@item N
2049@kindex N (Group)
2050@findex gnus-group-next-group
2051Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2052
2053@item P
2054@kindex P (Group)
2055@findex gnus-group-prev-group
2056Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2057
2058@item M-n
2059@kindex M-n (Group)
2060@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2061Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2062(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2063
2064@item M-p
2065@kindex M-p (Group)
2066@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2067Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2068(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2069@end table
2070
2071Three commands for jumping to groups:
2072
2073@table @kbd
2074
2075@item j
2076@kindex j (Group)
2077@findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2078Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2079(@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2080like living groups.
2081
2082@item ,
2083@kindex , (Group)
2084@findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2085Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2086(@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2087
2088@item .
2089@kindex . (Group)
2090@findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2091Jump to the first group with unread articles
2092(@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2093@end table
2094
2095@vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2096If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2097commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2098the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2099is @code{t}.
2100
01c52d31
MB
2101@vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2102If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2103exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2104Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2105@code{t}.
4009494e
GM
2106
2107@node Selecting a Group
2108@section Selecting a Group
2109@cindex group selection
2110
2111@table @kbd
2112
2113@item SPACE
2114@kindex SPACE (Group)
2115@findex gnus-group-read-group
2116Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2117first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2118unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2119this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2120group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2121determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2122positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2123negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2124
2125Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2126articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2127- 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2128
2129When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2130@kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2131ones.
2132
2133@item RET
2134@kindex RET (Group)
2135@findex gnus-group-select-group
2136Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2137(@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2138@code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2139does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2140entry.
2141
2142@item M-RET
2143@kindex M-RET (Group)
2144@findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2145This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2146minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2147scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2148expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2149enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2150(i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2151which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2152summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2153
2154@item M-SPACE
2155@kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2156@findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2157This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2158command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2159(@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2160
2161@item C-M-RET
2162@kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2163@findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2164Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2165doing any processing of its contents
2166(@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2167turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2168manner will have no permanent effects.
2169
2170@end table
2171
2172@vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2173The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2174consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2175considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2176(unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2177before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2178articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2179negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2180fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2181most recently will be fetched.
2182
2183@vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2184@code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2185@code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2186newsgroups.
2187
4b70e299 2188@vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
4009494e
GM
2189In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2190very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2191such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2192for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2193are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2194know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2195it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2196stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
4b70e299
MB
2197variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2198The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2199latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2200get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
220130000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2202prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2203variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2204means Gnus never ignores old articles.
4009494e
GM
2205
2206@vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2207@vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2208@vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2209If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2210automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2211Which article this is is controlled by the
2212@code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2213variable are:
2214
2215@table @code
2216
2217@item unread
2218Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2219
2220@item first
2221Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2222
2223@item unseen
2224Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2225
2226@item unseen-or-unread
2227Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2228there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2229unread article.
2230
2231@item best
2232Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2233
2234@end table
2235
2236This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2237will be called to place point on a subject line.
2238
2239If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2240binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2241@code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2242@code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2243selected.
2244
2245
2246@node Subscription Commands
2247@section Subscription Commands
2248@cindex subscription
2249
2250@table @kbd
2251
2252@item S t
2253@itemx u
2254@kindex S t (Group)
2255@kindex u (Group)
2256@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2257@c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2258Toggle subscription to the current group
2259(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2260
2261@item S s
2262@itemx U
2263@kindex S s (Group)
2264@kindex U (Group)
2265@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2266Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2267subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2268(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2269
2270@item S k
2271@itemx C-k
2272@kindex S k (Group)
2273@kindex C-k (Group)
2274@findex gnus-group-kill-group
2275@c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2276Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2277
2278@item S y
2279@itemx C-y
2280@kindex S y (Group)
2281@kindex C-y (Group)
2282@findex gnus-group-yank-group
2283Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2284
2285@item C-x C-t
2286@kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2287@findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2288Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2289really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2290kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2291
2292@item S w
2293@itemx C-w
2294@kindex S w (Group)
2295@kindex C-w (Group)
2296@findex gnus-group-kill-region
2297Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2298
2299@item S z
2300@kindex S z (Group)
2301@findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2302Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2303
2304@item S C-k
2305@kindex S C-k (Group)
2306@findex gnus-group-kill-level
2307Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2308These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2309be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2310really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2311groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2312kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2313@file{.newsrc} file.
2314
2315@end table
2316
2317Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2318
2319
2320@node Group Data
2321@section Group Data
2322
2323@table @kbd
2324
2325@item c
2326@kindex c (Group)
2327@findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2328@vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2329@c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2330Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2331(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2332@code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2333the group buffer.
2334
2335@item C
2336@kindex C (Group)
2337@findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2338Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2339(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2340
2341@item M-c
2342@kindex M-c (Group)
2343@findex gnus-group-clear-data
2344Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2345read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2346
2347@item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2348@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2349@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2350If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2351and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2352clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2353caution.
2354
2355@end table
2356
2357
2358@node Group Levels
2359@section Group Levels
2360@cindex group level
2361@cindex level
2362
2363All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2364group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2365can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2366(@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2367a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2368
2369Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2370
2371@table @kbd
2372
2373@item S l
2374@kindex S l (Group)
2375@findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2376Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2377next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2378prompted for a level.
2379@end table
2380
2381@vindex gnus-level-killed
2382@vindex gnus-level-zombie
2383@vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2384@vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2385Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2386@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2387@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2388@code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2389unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2390(default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2391(default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2392same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2393you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2394groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2395reasons of efficiency.
2396
2397It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2398low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2399
2400Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2401understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2402subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2403empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2404go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2405groups are hidden, in a way.
2406
2407Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2408are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2409unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2410information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2411and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2412aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2413
2414Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2415a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2416group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2417but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2418the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2419list of killed groups.)
2420
2421If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2422Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2423them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2424
2425@vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2426@vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2427Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2428(default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2429which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2430(un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2431relevant valid ranges.
2432
2433@vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2434If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2435will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2436particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2437will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2438handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2439rest.
2440
2441If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2442one with the best level.
2443
2444@vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2445All groups with a level less than or equal to
2446@code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2447by default.
2448
2449@vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2450If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2451groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2452@code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2453listed.
2454
2455@vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2456If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2457give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2458use this level as the ``work'' level.
2459
2460@vindex gnus-activate-level
2461Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2462on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2463activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2464to 5. The default is 6.
2465
2466
2467@node Group Score
2468@section Group Score
2469@cindex group score
2470@cindex group rank
2471@cindex rank
2472
2473You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2474is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2475group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2476reason?
2477
2478This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2479to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2480the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2481score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2482called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2483a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2484of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2485least significant part.))
2486
2487@findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2488If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2489read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2490the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2491sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2492action after each summary exit, you can add
2493@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2494@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2495slow things down somewhat.
2496
2497
2498@node Marking Groups
2499@section Marking Groups
2500@cindex marking groups
2501
2502If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2503subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2504numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2505bidding on those groups.
2506
2507However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2508perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2509with the process mark and then execute the command.
2510
2511@table @kbd
2512
2513@item #
2514@kindex # (Group)
2515@itemx M m
2516@kindex M m (Group)
2517@findex gnus-group-mark-group
2518Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2519
2520@item M-#
2521@kindex M-# (Group)
2522@itemx M u
2523@kindex M u (Group)
2524@findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2525Remove the mark from the current group
2526(@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2527
2528@item M U
2529@kindex M U (Group)
2530@findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2531Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2532
2533@item M w
2534@kindex M w (Group)
2535@findex gnus-group-mark-region
2536Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2537
2538@item M b
2539@kindex M b (Group)
2540@findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2541Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2542
2543@item M r
2544@kindex M r (Group)
2545@findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2546Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2547(@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2548@end table
2549
2550Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2551
2552@findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2553If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2554with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2555(@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2556the command to be executed.
2557
2558
2559@node Foreign Groups
2560@section Foreign Groups
2561@cindex foreign groups
2562
2563Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2564groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2565special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2566groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2567consulted.
2568
2569Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2570@file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2571variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2572
2573@table @kbd
2574
2575@item G m
2576@kindex G m (Group)
2577@findex gnus-group-make-group
2578@cindex making groups
2579Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2580for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2581to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2582
2583@item G M
2584@kindex G M (Group)
2585@findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2586Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2587will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2588
2589@item G r
2590@kindex G r (Group)
2591@findex gnus-group-rename-group
2592@cindex renaming groups
2593Rename the current group to something else
2594(@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2595groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2596on some back ends.
2597
2598@item G c
2599@kindex G c (Group)
2600@cindex customizing
2601@findex gnus-group-customize
2602Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2603
2604@item G e
2605@kindex G e (Group)
2606@findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2607@cindex renaming groups
2608Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2609group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2610
2611@item G p
2612@kindex G p (Group)
2613@findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2614Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2615(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2616
2617@item G E
2618@kindex G E (Group)
2619@findex gnus-group-edit-group
2620Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2621(@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2622
2623@item G d
2624@kindex G d (Group)
2625@findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2626@cindex nndir
2627Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2628for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2629
2630@item G h
2631@kindex G h (Group)
2632@cindex help group
2633@findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2634Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2635
2636@item G a
2637@kindex G a (Group)
2638@cindex (ding) archive
2639@cindex archive group
2640@findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2641@vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2642@vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2643Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2644default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2645(@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2646group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2647
2648@item G k
2649@kindex G k (Group)
2650@findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2651@cindex nnkiboze
2652Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2653match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2654strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2655@xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2656
2657@item G D
2658@kindex G D (Group)
2659@findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2660@cindex nneething
2661Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2662@code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2663@xref{Anything Groups}.
2664
2665@item G f
2666@kindex G f (Group)
2667@findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2668@cindex ClariNet Briefs
2669@cindex nndoc
2670Make a group based on some file or other
2671(@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2672command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2673Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2674@code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2675@code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2676@code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2677@code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2678you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2679type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2680
2681@item G u
2682@kindex G u (Group)
2683@vindex gnus-useful-groups
2684@findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2685Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2686(@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2687
2688@item G w
2689@kindex G w (Group)
2690@findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2691@cindex Google
2692@cindex nnweb
2693@cindex gmane
2694Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2695(@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2696command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2697search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2698include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2699@xref{Web Searches}.
2700
2701If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2702to a particular group by using a match string like
2703@samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2704
2705@item G R
2706@kindex G R (Group)
2707@findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2708Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2709(@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2710@xref{RSS}.
2711
2712@item G DEL
2713@kindex G DEL (Group)
2714@findex gnus-group-delete-group
2715This function will delete the current group
2716(@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2717actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2718group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2719absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2720read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2721
2722@item G V
2723@kindex G V (Group)
2724@findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2725Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2726(@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2727
2728@item G v
2729@kindex G v (Group)
2730@findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2731Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2732(@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2733@end table
2734
2735@xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2736methods.
2737
2738@vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2739If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2740Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2741This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2742groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2743@code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2744newsgroups.
2745
2746
9b3ebcb6
MB
2747The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2748only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2749
2750@table @code
2751@item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2752@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2753@vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2754Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2755HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2756Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2757the article range.
2758
2759@item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2760@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2761This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2762the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2763given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include e.g.
2764@url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2765@url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2766@url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2767@url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2768@url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2769
2770@item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2771@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2772Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2773bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2774specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2775
2776@item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2777@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2778Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2779@code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2780@end table
2781
2782Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2783Buttons}.
2784
2785Here is an example:
2786@lisp
2787(require 'gnus-art)
2788(add-to-list
2789 'gnus-button-alist
2790 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2791 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2792 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2793@end lisp
2794
2795
4009494e
GM
2796@node Group Parameters
2797@section Group Parameters
2798@cindex group parameters
2799
2800The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
87035689
MB
2801
2802Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2803group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2804presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2805silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2806parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2807Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2808@code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2809
4009494e
GM
2810Here's an example group parameter list:
2811
2812@example
2813((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2814 (auto-expire . t))
2815@end example
2816
2817We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2818the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2819parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2820not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2821
2822Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2823is an alist of regexps and values.
2824
2825The following group parameters can be used:
2826
2827@table @code
2828@item to-address
2829@cindex to-address
2830Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2831
2832@example
2833(to-address . "some@@where.com")
2834@end example
2835
2836This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2837lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2838the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2839ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2840that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2841
2842Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2843or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2844@samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2845the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2846group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2847list address instead.
2848
2849See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2850
2851@item to-list
2852@cindex to-list
2853Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2854
2855@example
2856(to-list . "some@@where.com")
2857@end example
2858
2859It is totally ignored
2860when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2861you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2862
2863If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2864@code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2865then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2866sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2867@vindex gnus-add-to-list
2868
2869@findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2870@cindex mail list groups
2871If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2872entering summary buffer.
2873
2874See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2875
2876@anchor{subscribed}
2877@item subscribed
2878@cindex subscribed
2879@cindex Mail-Followup-To
2880@findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2881If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2882to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2883mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2884(only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2885headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2886following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2887
2888@lisp
2889(setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2890 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2891@end lisp
2892
2893@xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2894a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2895
2896@item visible
2897@cindex visible
2898If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2899that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2900of whether it has any unread articles.
2901
2902This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2903@code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2904
2905@item broken-reply-to
2906@cindex broken-reply-to
2907Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2908headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2909if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2910can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2911has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2912itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2913
2914@item to-group
2915@cindex to-group
2916Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2917posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2918
2919@item newsgroup
2920@cindex newsgroup
2921If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2922will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2923This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2924news group.
2925
2926@item gcc-self
2927@cindex gcc-self
2928If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2929composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2930@code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2931generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2932be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2933precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2934(@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2935
2936@strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2937@code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2938doesn't accept articles.
2939
2940@item auto-expire
2941@cindex auto-expire
2942@cindex expiring mail
2943If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2944. t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2945alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2946
2947See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2948
2949@item total-expire
2950@cindex total-expire
2951@cindex expiring mail
2952If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2953@code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2954expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2955caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2956expiry.
2957
2958See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2959
2960@item expiry-wait
2961@cindex expiry-wait
2962@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2963If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2964@code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2965@code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2966(@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2967can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2968symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2969
2970@item expiry-target
2971@cindex expiry-target
2972Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2973@code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2974
2975@item score-file
2976@cindex score file group parameter
2977Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2978@file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2979interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2980
2981@item adapt-file
2982@cindex adapt file group parameter
2983Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2984@file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2985All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2986
2987@item admin-address
2988@cindex admin-address
2989When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2990unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2991messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2992put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2993
2994@item display
2995@cindex display
2996Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2997display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2998
2999@table @code
3000@item all
3001Display all articles, both read and unread.
3002
3003@item an integer
3004Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
3005entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
3006
3007@item default
3008Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
3009ticked articles.
3010
3011@item an array
3012Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
3013
3014Here are some examples:
3015
3016@table @code
3017@item [unread]
3018Display only unread articles.
3019
3020@item [not expire]
3021Display everything except expirable articles.
3022
3023@item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
3024Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
3025responded to.
3026@end table
3027
3028The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
3029Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
3030@code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
3031@code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
3032@code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
3033
3034@end table
3035
3036The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
3037the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
3038command (@pxref{Limiting}).
3039
3040@item comment
3041@cindex comment
3042Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
3043arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
3044group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
3045
3046@item charset
3047@cindex charset
3048Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3049@code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3050used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3051
3052See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3053
3054@item ignored-charsets
3055@cindex ignored-charset
3056Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3057will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3058default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3059
3060See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3061
3062@item posting-style
3063@cindex posting-style
3064You can store additional posting style information for this group
3065here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3066@code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3067the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3068take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3069
3070For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3071instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3072like this in the group parameters:
3073
3074@example
3075(posting-style
3076 (name "Funky Name")
3077 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3078 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3079@end example
3080
01c52d31
MB
3081If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3082(@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3083the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3084groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3085group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3086entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3087to.
3088
3089
4009494e
GM
3090@item post-method
3091@cindex post-method
3092If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3093instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3094
a1da1e37
MB
3095@item mail-source
3096@cindex mail-source
3097If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3098@code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3099mail source for this group.
3100
4009494e
GM
3101@item banner
3102@cindex banner
3103An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3104that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3105@var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3106last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3107@code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3108
3109@item sieve
3110@cindex sieve
3111This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3112that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3113Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3114condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3115
3116For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3117address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3118translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3119Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3120
3121@example
01c52d31
MB
3122if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3123 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3124@}
3125@end example
3126
3127To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3128like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3129When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3130like the following is generated:
3131
3132@example
3133if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3134 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
4009494e
GM
3135@}
3136@end example
3137
01c52d31
MB
3138See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3139interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3140
4009494e
GM
3141The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3142Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3143
3144@item (agent parameters)
3145If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
3146to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3147Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3148agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3149minimize the configuration effort.
3150
3151@item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3152You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3153are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3154you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3155that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3156in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3157@code{eval}ed there.
3158
e3e955fe
MB
3159Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3160if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3161only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3162variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3163form needs to be set to it.
3164
4009494e
GM
3165But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3166message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3167message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3168question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3169Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3170parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
e6d2d263 3171@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e
GM
3172
3173@lisp
3174(add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3175@end lisp
3176
3177@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3178A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3179the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3180
3181@example
3182nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3183@end example
3184
3185has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3186tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3187the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3188into the group parameters for the group.
3189
3190This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3191hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
e3e955fe
MB
3192@code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3193@code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3194(meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
4009494e
GM
3195
3196Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3197pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3198following is added to a group parameter
3199
3200@lisp
3201(gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3202 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3203@end lisp
3204
3205when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3206expired.
3207
3208@end table
3209
4009494e
GM
3210@vindex gnus-parameters
3211Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3212But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3213case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3214For example:
3215
3216@lisp
3217(setq gnus-parameters
3218 '(("mail\\..*"
3219 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3220 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3221 (gnus-summary-line-format
3222 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3223 (gcc-self . t)
3224 (display . all))
3225
3226 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3227 (to-group . "\\1"))
3228
3229 ("mail\\.me"
3230 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3231
3232 ("list\\..*"
3233 (total-expire . t)
3234 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3235@end lisp
3236
3237String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3238the @code{to-group} example shows.
3239
3240@vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3241By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3242specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3243or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3244@code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3245value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3246example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3247applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3248group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3249value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3250@code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3251always in a case-insensitive manner.
3252
01c52d31
MB
3253You can define different sorting to different groups via
3254@code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3255group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3256@acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3257Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3258news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3259weekly news RSS feed
3260@url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3261@xref{RSS}.
3262
3263@lisp
3264(setq
3265 gnus-parameters
3266 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3267 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3268 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3269 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3270 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3271 ("nnrss.*debian"
3272 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3273 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3274 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3275 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3276 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3277 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3278@end lisp
3279
4009494e
GM
3280
3281@node Listing Groups
3282@section Listing Groups
3283@cindex group listing
3284
3285These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3286
3287@table @kbd
3288
3289@item l
3290@itemx A s
3291@kindex A s (Group)
3292@kindex l (Group)
3293@findex gnus-group-list-groups
3294List all groups that have unread articles
3295(@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3296command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3297only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3298@code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3299groups).
3300
3301@item L
3302@itemx A u
3303@kindex A u (Group)
3304@kindex L (Group)
3305@findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3306List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3307(@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3308this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3309it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3310unsubscribed groups).
3311
3312@item A l
3313@kindex A l (Group)
3314@findex gnus-group-list-level
3315List all unread groups on a specific level
3316(@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3317with no unread articles.
3318
3319@item A k
3320@kindex A k (Group)
3321@findex gnus-group-list-killed
3322List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3323prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3324currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3325from the server.
3326
3327@item A z
3328@kindex A z (Group)
3329@findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3330List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3331
3332@item A m
3333@kindex A m (Group)
3334@findex gnus-group-list-matching
3335List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3336(@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3337
3338@item A M
3339@kindex A M (Group)
3340@findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3341List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3342
3343@item A A
3344@kindex A A (Group)
3345@findex gnus-group-list-active
3346List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3347server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3348might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3349to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3350thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3351don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3352Take the output with some grains of salt.
3353
3354@item A a
3355@kindex A a (Group)
3356@findex gnus-group-apropos
3357List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3358(@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3359
3360@item A d
3361@kindex A d (Group)
3362@findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3363List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3364(@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3365
3366@item A c
3367@kindex A c (Group)
3368@findex gnus-group-list-cached
3369List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3370
3371@item A ?
3372@kindex A ? (Group)
3373@findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3374List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3375
3376@item A /
3377@kindex A / (Group)
3378@findex gnus-group-list-limit
3379List groups limited within the current selection
3380(@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3381
3382@item A f
3383@kindex A f (Group)
3384@findex gnus-group-list-flush
3385Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3386
3387@item A p
3388@kindex A p (Group)
3389@findex gnus-group-list-plus
3390List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3391
3392@end table
3393
3394@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3395@cindex visible group parameter
3396Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3397always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3398add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3399get the same effect.
3400
3401@vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3402Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3403group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3404@code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3405groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3406
3407
3408@node Sorting Groups
3409@section Sorting Groups
3410@cindex sorting groups
3411
3412@kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3413@findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3414@vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3415The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3416group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3417@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3418include:
3419
3420@table @code
3421
3422@item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3423@findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3424Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3425
3426@item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3427@findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3428Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3429
3430@item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3431@findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3432Sort by group level.
3433
3434@item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3435@findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3436Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3437
3438@item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3439@findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3440Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3441are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3442
3443@item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3444@findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3445Sort by number of unread articles.
3446
3447@item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3448@findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3449Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3450
3451@item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3452@findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3453Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3454
3455
3456@end table
3457
3458@code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3459functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3460the last one.
3461
3462
3463There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3464some sorting criteria:
3465
3466@table @kbd
3467@item G S a
3468@kindex G S a (Group)
3469@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3470Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3471(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3472
3473@item G S u
3474@kindex G S u (Group)
3475@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3476Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3477(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3478
3479@item G S l
3480@kindex G S l (Group)
3481@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3482Sort the group buffer by group level
3483(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3484
3485@item G S v
3486@kindex G S v (Group)
3487@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3488Sort the group buffer by group score
3489(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3490
3491@item G S r
3492@kindex G S r (Group)
3493@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3494Sort the group buffer by group rank
3495(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3496
3497@item G S m
3498@kindex G S m (Group)
3499@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3500Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3501(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3502
3503@item G S n
3504@kindex G S n (Group)
3505@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3506Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3507(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3508
3509@end table
3510
3511All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3512(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3513
3514When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3515commands will sort in reverse order.
3516
3517You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3518
3519@table @kbd
3520@item G P a
3521@kindex G P a (Group)
3522@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3523Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3524(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3525
3526@item G P u
3527@kindex G P u (Group)
3528@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3529Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3530(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3531
3532@item G P l
3533@kindex G P l (Group)
3534@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3535Sort the groups by group level
3536(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3537
3538@item G P v
3539@kindex G P v (Group)
3540@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3541Sort the groups by group score
3542(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3543
3544@item G P r
3545@kindex G P r (Group)
3546@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3547Sort the groups by group rank
3548(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3549
3550@item G P m
3551@kindex G P m (Group)
3552@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3553Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3554(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3555
3556@item G P n
3557@kindex G P n (Group)
3558@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3559Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3560(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3561
3562@item G P s
3563@kindex G P s (Group)
3564@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3565Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3566
3567@end table
3568
3569And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3570move groups around.
3571
3572
3573@node Group Maintenance
3574@section Group Maintenance
3575@cindex bogus groups
3576
3577@table @kbd
3578@item b
3579@kindex b (Group)
3580@findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3581Find bogus groups and delete them
3582(@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3583
3584@item F
3585@kindex F (Group)
3586@findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3587Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3588With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3589for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3590to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3591zombies.
3592
3593@item C-c C-x
3594@kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3595@findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3596@cindex expiring mail
3597Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3598process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3599all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3600(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3601
3602@item C-c C-M-x
3603@kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3604@findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3605@cindex expiring mail
3606Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3607(@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3608
3609@end table
3610
3611
3612@node Browse Foreign Server
3613@section Browse Foreign Server
3614@cindex foreign servers
3615@cindex browsing servers
3616
3617@table @kbd
3618@item B
3619@kindex B (Group)
3620@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3621You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3622then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3623(@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3624@end table
3625
3626@findex gnus-browse-mode
3627A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3628will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3629a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3630
3631Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3632
3633@table @kbd
3634@item n
3635@kindex n (Browse)
3636@findex gnus-group-next-group
3637Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3638
3639@item p
3640@kindex p (Browse)
3641@findex gnus-group-prev-group
3642Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3643
3644@item SPACE
3645@kindex SPACE (Browse)
3646@findex gnus-browse-read-group
3647Enter the current group and display the first article
3648(@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3649
3650@item RET
3651@kindex RET (Browse)
3652@findex gnus-browse-select-group
3653Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3654
3655@item u
3656@kindex u (Browse)
3657@findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3658Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3659subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3660
3661@item l
3662@itemx q
3663@kindex q (Browse)
3664@kindex l (Browse)
3665@findex gnus-browse-exit
3666Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3667
3668@item d
3669@kindex d (Browse)
3670@findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3671Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3672
3673@item ?
3674@kindex ? (Browse)
3675@findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3676Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3677there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3678@end table
3679
3680
3681@node Exiting Gnus
3682@section Exiting Gnus
3683@cindex exiting Gnus
3684
3685Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3686
3687@table @kbd
3688@item z
3689@kindex z (Group)
3690@findex gnus-group-suspend
3691Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3692but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3693is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3694
3695@item q
3696@kindex q (Group)
3697@findex gnus-group-exit
3698@c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3699Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3700
3701@item Q
3702@kindex Q (Group)
3703@findex gnus-group-quit
3704Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3705The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3706@end table
3707
3708@vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3709@vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3710@vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3711@code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3712@code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3713@code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3714exiting Gnus.
3715
3716Note:
3717
3718@quotation
3719Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3720numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3721behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3722plastic chair.
3723@end quotation
3724
3725
3726@node Group Topics
3727@section Group Topics
3728@cindex topics
3729
3730If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3731them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3732here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3733you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3734even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3735groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3736
3737@iftex
3738@iflatex
3739\gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3740\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3741}
3742@end iflatex
3743@end iftex
3744
3745Here's an example:
3746
3747@example
3748Gnus
3749 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3750 3: comp.emacs
3751 2: alt.religion.emacs
3752 Naughty Emacs
3753 452: alt.sex.emacs
3754 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3755 Misc
3756 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3757 13: comp.sources.unix
3758@end example
3759
3760@findex gnus-topic-mode
3761@kindex t (Group)
3762To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3763@code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3764is a toggling command.)
3765
3766Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3767dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3768Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3769under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3770Hot and bothered?
3771
3772If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3773the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3774@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3775
3776@lisp
3777(add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3778@end lisp
3779
3780@menu
3781* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3782* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3783* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3784* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3785* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3786@end menu
3787
3788
3789@node Topic Commands
3790@subsection Topic Commands
3791@cindex topic commands
3792
3793When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3794available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3795definitions slightly.
3796
3797In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3798First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3799groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3800like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3801shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3802groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3803
3804Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3805the way you like.
3806
3807@table @kbd
3808
3809@item T n
3810@kindex T n (Topic)
3811@findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3812Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3813(@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3814
3815@item T TAB
3816@itemx TAB
3817@kindex T TAB (Topic)
3818@kindex TAB (Topic)
3819@findex gnus-topic-indent
3820``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3821previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3822``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3823
3824@item M-TAB
3825@kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3826@findex gnus-topic-unindent
3827``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3828parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3829
3830@end table
3831
3832The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3833They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3834@kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3835kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3836
3837@table @kbd
3838
3839@item C-k
3840@kindex C-k (Topic)
3841@findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3842Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3843topic will be removed along with the topic.
3844
3845@item C-y
3846@kindex C-y (Topic)
3847@findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3848Yank the previously killed group or topic
3849(@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3850before all groups.
3851
3852So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3853@kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3854move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3855topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3856paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3857
3858You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3859you can move topics around as well as groups.
3860
3861@end table
3862
3863After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3864hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3865key.
3866
3867@table @kbd
3868
3869@item RET
3870@kindex RET (Topic)
3871@findex gnus-topic-select-group
3872@itemx SPACE
3873Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3874When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3875usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3876visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3877toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3878prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3879
3880@end table
3881
3882Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3883
3884@table @kbd
3885
3886@item T m
3887@kindex T m (Topic)
3888@findex gnus-topic-move-group
3889Move the current group to some other topic
3890(@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3891convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3892
3893@item T j
3894@kindex T j (Topic)
3895@findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3896Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3897
3898@item T c
3899@kindex T c (Topic)
3900@findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3901Copy the current group to some other topic
3902(@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3903convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3904
3905@item T h
3906@kindex T h (Topic)
3907@findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3908Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3909a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3910
3911@item T s
3912@kindex T s (Topic)
3913@findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3914Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3915a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3916
3917@item T D
3918@kindex T D (Topic)
3919@findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3920Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3921This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3922topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3923remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3924the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3925(which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3926topic.
3927
3928This command uses the process/prefix convention
3929(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3930
3931@item T M
3932@kindex T M (Topic)
3933@findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3934Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3935(@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3936
3937@item T C
3938@kindex T C (Topic)
3939@findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3940Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3941(@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3942
3943@item T H
3944@kindex T H (Topic)
3945@findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3946Toggle hiding empty topics
3947(@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3948
3949@item T #
3950@kindex T # (Topic)
3951@findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3952Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3953(@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3954sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3955
3956@item T M-#
3957@kindex T M-# (Topic)
3958@findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3959Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3960(@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3961sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3962
3963@item C-c C-x
3964@kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3965@findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3966@cindex expiring mail
3967Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3968expiry process (if any)
3969(@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3970
3971@item T r
3972@kindex T r (Topic)
3973@findex gnus-topic-rename
3974Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3975
3976@item T DEL
3977@kindex T DEL (Topic)
3978@findex gnus-topic-delete
3979Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3980
3981@item A T
3982@kindex A T (Topic)
3983@findex gnus-topic-list-active
3984List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3985(@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3986
3987@item T M-n
3988@kindex T M-n (Topic)
3989@findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3990Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3991
3992@item T M-p
3993@kindex T M-p (Topic)
3994@findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
01c52d31 3995Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
4009494e
GM
3996
3997@item G p
3998@kindex G p (Topic)
3999@findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
4000@cindex group parameters
4001@cindex topic parameters
4002@cindex parameters
4003Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
4004@xref{Topic Parameters}.
4005
4006@end table
4007
4008
4009@node Topic Variables
4010@subsection Topic Variables
4011@cindex topic variables
4012
4013The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
4014This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
4015
4016@vindex gnus-topic-line-format
4017The topic lines themselves are created according to the
4018@code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4019Valid elements are:
4020
4021@table @samp
4022@item i
4023Indentation.
4024@item n
4025Topic name.
4026@item v
4027Visibility.
4028@item l
4029Level.
4030@item g
4031Number of groups in the topic.
4032@item a
4033Number of unread articles in the topic.
4034@item A
4035Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4036@end table
4037
4038@vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4039Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4040@code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4041The default is 2.
4042
4043@vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4044@code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4045
4046@vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4047The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4048topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4049
4050
4051@node Topic Sorting
4052@subsection Topic Sorting
4053@cindex topic sorting
4054
4055You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4056commands:
4057
4058
4059@table @kbd
4060@item T S a
4061@kindex T S a (Topic)
4062@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4063Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4064(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4065
4066@item T S u
4067@kindex T S u (Topic)
4068@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4069Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4070(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4071
4072@item T S l
4073@kindex T S l (Topic)
4074@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4075Sort the current topic by group level
4076(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4077
4078@item T S v
4079@kindex T S v (Topic)
4080@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4081Sort the current topic by group score
4082(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4083
4084@item T S r
4085@kindex T S r (Topic)
4086@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4087Sort the current topic by group rank
4088(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4089
4090@item T S m
4091@kindex T S m (Topic)
4092@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4093Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4094(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4095
4096@item T S e
4097@kindex T S e (Topic)
4098@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4099Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4100(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4101
4102@item T S s
4103@kindex T S s (Topic)
4104@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4105Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4106@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4107(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4108
4109@end table
4110
4111When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4112order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4113sorting.
4114
4115
4116@node Topic Topology
4117@subsection Topic Topology
4118@cindex topic topology
4119@cindex topology
4120
4121So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4122
4123@example
4124@group
4125Gnus
4126 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4127 3: comp.emacs
4128 2: alt.religion.emacs
4129 Naughty Emacs
4130 452: alt.sex.emacs
4131 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4132 Misc
4133 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4134 13: comp.sources.unix
4135@end group
4136@end example
4137
4138So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4139that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4140just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4141follows:
4142
4143@lisp
4144(("Gnus" visible)
4145 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4146 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4147 (("Misc" visible)))
4148@end lisp
4149
4150@vindex gnus-topic-topology
4151This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4152for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4153file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4154to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4155setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4156
4157This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4158and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4159allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4160
4161
4162@node Topic Parameters
4163@subsection Topic Parameters
4164@cindex topic parameters
4165
4166All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4167(and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4168topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4169enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4170Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4171
4172In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4173parameters:
4174
4175@table @code
4176@item subscribe
4177When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4178@code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4179value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4180topic.
4181
4182@item subscribe-level
4183When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4184the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4185@code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4186
4187@end table
4188
4189Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4190parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4191know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4192verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4193
4194@example
4195@group
4196Gnus
4197 Emacs
4198 3: comp.emacs
4199 2: alt.religion.emacs
4200 452: alt.sex.emacs
4201 Relief
4202 452: alt.sex.emacs
4203 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4204 Misc
4205 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4206 13: comp.sources.unix
4207 452: alt.sex.emacs
4208@end group
4209@end example
4210
4211The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4212. "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4213@code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4214topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4215@* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4216. "religion.SCORE")}.
4217
4218Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4219will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4220group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4221score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4222get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4223
4224This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4225there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4226parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4227@code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4228gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4229of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4230happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4231happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4232
4233
01c52d31
MB
4234@node Non-ASCII Group Names
4235@section Accessing groups of non-English names
4236@cindex non-ascii group names
4237
4238There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4239expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4240certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4241spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4242course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4243supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4244back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4245back end.
4246
4247Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4248side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4249charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4250Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4251article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4252with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4253non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4254the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4255
4256@table @code
4257@item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4258@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4259An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4260@code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4261method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4262
4263@lisp
4264(setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4265 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4266@end lisp
4267
4268Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4269ones specified for the same groups with the
4270@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4271
4272A select method can be very long, like:
4273
4274@lisp
4275(nntp "gmane"
4276 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4277 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4278 (nntp-open-connection-function
4279 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4280 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4281 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4282 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4283 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4284@end lisp
4285
4286In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4287variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4288the server name.
4289
4290@item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4291@cindex UTF-8 group names
4292@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4293An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4294@code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4295otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4296
4297@lisp
4298(setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4299 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4300 (".*" . utf-8)))
4301@end lisp
4302
4303Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4304@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4305@end table
4306
4307Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4308and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4309other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4310you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4311all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4312@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4313
4314There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
26b9f88d 4315names:
01c52d31
MB
4316
4317@table @code
4318@item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
26b9f88d
MB
4319@vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4320The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4321default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4322named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4323@code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4324
4325The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the @acronym{NNTP}
4326marks feature (@pxref{NNTP marks}), the agent, and the cache use
4327non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and directories. This
4328variable overrides the value of @code{file-name-coding-system} which
4329specifies the coding system used when encoding and decoding those file
4330names and directory names.
01c52d31
MB
4331
4332In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4333is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
26b9f88d 4334file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
01c52d31 4335@code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
26b9f88d
MB
4336is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4337@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4338
4339Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4340@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4341to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4342to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
01c52d31
MB
4343
4344The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4345does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4346@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4347@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4348
26b9f88d
MB
4349If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4350initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4351want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4352typical case where you have to customize
4353@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4354a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4355system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4356may be initialized to an appropriate value.
01c52d31
MB
4357@end table
4358
4359Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4360group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4361names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4362header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4363
4364
e6d2d263
MB
4365@node Searching
4366@section Searching
4367
4368@menu
4369* nnir:: Searching on IMAP, with swish, namazu, etc.
4370* nnmairix:: Searching maildir, MH or mbox with Mairix.
4371@end menu
4372
4373@cindex Searching
4374
4375FIXME: This node is a stub.
4376
4377FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
4378comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
4379as well.
4380
4381FIXME: Explain difference to @ref{Searching for Articles}, add reference
4382and back-reference.
4383
4384@node nnir
4385@subsection nnir
4386
4387FIXME: As a first step, convert the commentary of @file{nnir} to texi.
4388@cindex nnir
4389
4390@node nnmairix
4391@subsection nnmairix
4392
4393@cindex mairix
4394@cindex nnmairix
4395This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
4396@code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
4397Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
4398bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
4399
4400@menu
4401* About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
4402* nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
4403* What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
4404* Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
4405* Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
4406* nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
4407* Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
4408* nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
4409* nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
4410@end menu
4411
2b968687
MB
4412@c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
4413@c E.g. adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
4414@c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
e6d2d263
MB
4415
4416@node About mairix
4417@subsubsection About mairix
4418
4419Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
4420mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
4421GPL. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
4422runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
4423be found at
4424@uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
4425
4426Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
4427swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
4428has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
4429can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
4430thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
4431necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
4432done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
4433therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
4434up.
4435
4436For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
4437@code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
4438end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
4439results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
4440which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
4441made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
4442mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
4443for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
4444searches. This is similar to a Kiboze group (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}),
4445but much faster.
4446
4447@node nnmairix requirements
4448@subsubsection nnmairix requirements
4449
2b968687 4450Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
e6d2d263
MB
4451direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
4452server (e.g. an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
4453access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g. via ssh.
4454
4455Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
2b968687
MB
4456ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
4457one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
4458@code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
e6d2d263
MB
4459
4460If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
4461you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
4462@code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
030cca00
MB
4463files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
4464really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
4465the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
e6d2d263
MB
4466
4467@node What nnmairix does
4468@subsubsection What nnmairix does
4469
4470The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
4471either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
4472database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
4473several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g. to quickly
4474search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
4475display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
4476mails are in different folders.
4477
4478Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
4479to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
4480containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
4481even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID. If you check for
4482new mail in these folders (e.g. by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
4483automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
4484
4485You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
4486creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
030cca00 4487then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
2b968687 4488does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
e6d2d263
MB
4489strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
4490claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
4491the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
4492its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g. if you
4493use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
4494about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
4495group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
4496
030cca00
MB
4497@code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
4498a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
4499the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
4500different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
4501@code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
4502binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
e6d2d263 4503@code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
030cca00
MB
4504present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
4505You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
4506but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
4507groups alongside your other mail, you can also create e.g. a new
4508@code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
4509make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
4510(@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
4511mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
4512folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
e6d2d263
MB
4513
4514@node Setting up mairix
4515@subsubsection Setting up mairix
4516
4517First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
4518
4519Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
4520(at least) the following entries:
4521
4522@example
4523# Your Maildir/MH base folder
4524base=~/Maildir
4525@end example
4526
2b968687
MB
4527This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
4528are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
4529with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
4530directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
e6d2d263 4531
e6d2d263
MB
4532@example
4533maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
4534mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
4535mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
4536@end example
4537
9e601b8d
MB
4538This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
4539base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
4540@code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
4541directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
4542section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
e6d2d263
MB
4543
4544@example
4545omit=zz_mairix-*
4546@end example
4547
4548@vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
4549This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
4550search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
4551variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
4552
e6d2d263
MB
4553@example
4554mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
4555database= ... location of database file ...
4556@end example
4557
4558The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
4559search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
4560with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
4561
2b968687
MB
4562To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
4563
4564@example
4565base=~/Maildir
4566maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
4567mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
4568mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
4569mformat=maildir
4570omit=zz_mairix-*
4571database=~/.mairixdatabase
4572@end example
4573
4574In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
4575folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
4576colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
4577because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
4578@code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
4579@code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
4580to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
4581notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
4582to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
4583dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
4584old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
4585The other lines should be obvious.
4586
4587See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
4588especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
4589than you are used to.
4590
4591Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
4592Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
4593the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
e6d2d263
MB
4594
4595@node Configuring nnmairix
4596@subsubsection Configuring nnmairix
4597
4598In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
4599(@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
4600necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
4601server. You will have to specify the following:
4602
4603@itemize @bullet
4604
4605@item
2b968687 4606The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
e6d2d263
MB
4607want.
4608
4609@item
9e601b8d
MB
4610The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
4611searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
4612Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
4613which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
4614@code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
4615mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
030cca00
MB
4616However, you can also create e.g. a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
4617server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
4618(@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
4619just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
4620@code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might loose mail
4621(@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
9e601b8d
MB
4622@acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
4623@code{nnimap} server here.
e6d2d263
MB
4624
4625@item
4626@vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
4627The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
4628be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
4629SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g. on your
4630@acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
4631mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
4632@code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
4633
4634@item
4635The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
4636where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e. all searches which
4637are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
4638like.
4639
4640@item
4641If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
4642asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e. with hidden maildir
4643folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
4644@samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
4645server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
4646
4647@end itemize
4648
4649@node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
4650@subsubsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
4651
4652In group mode:
4653
4654@table @kbd
4655
4656@item G b c
4657@kindex G b c (Group)
4658@findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
4659Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
4660(@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
4661this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
4662
4663@item G b s
4664@kindex G b s (Group)
4665@findex nnmairix-search
4666Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
4667results are put into the default search group which is automatically
4668displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
4669
4670@item G b m
4671@kindex G b m (Group)
4672@findex nnmairix-widget-search
4673Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
4674comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
4675group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
4676
4677@item G b i
4678@kindex G b i (Group)
4679@findex nnmairix-search-interactive
4680Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
4681only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
4682
4683@item G b g
4684@kindex G b g (Group)
4685@findex nnmairix-create-search-group
4686Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
4687(@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
4688automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
4689@kbd{M-g}.
4690
4691@item G b q
4692@kindex G b q (Group)
4693@findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
4694Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
4695(@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
4696
4697@item G b t
4698@kindex G b t (Group)
4699@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
4700Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
4701i.e. if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
4702(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
4703
4704@item G b u
4705@kindex G b u (Group)
4706@findex nnmairix-update-database
4707@vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
4708Calls mairix binary for updating the database
4709(@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
4710and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
4711@code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
4712options).
4713
4714@item G b r
4715@kindex G b r (Group)
4716@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
4717Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
4718marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
4719
4720@item G b d
4721@kindex G b d (Group)
4722@findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
4723Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
4724(@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
4725you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
4726
4727@item G b a
4728@kindex G b a (Group)
4729@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
4730Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
4731(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
4732behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
4733update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
4734mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
4735upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
4736lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
4737entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
4738
4739@item G b p
4740@kindex G b p (Group)
4741@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
4742Toggle marks propagation for this group
4743(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
4744marks}).
4745
4746@item G b o
4747@kindex G b o (Group)
4748@findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
4749Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
4750@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
4751
4752@end table
4753
4754In summary mode:
4755
4756@table @kbd
4757
4758@item $ m
4759@kindex $ m (Summary)
4760@findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
4761Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
4762message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
4763(@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
4764
4765@item $ g
4766@kindex $ g (Summary)
4767@findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
4768Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
4769message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
4770(@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
4771
4772@item $ t
4773@kindex $ t (Summary)
4774@findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
4775Searches thread for the current article
4776(@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
4777shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
4778current article and enabled threads.
4779
4780@item $ f
4781@kindex $ f (Summary)
4782@findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
4783Searches all messages from sender of the current article
4784(@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
4785calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
4786
4787@item $ o
4788@kindex $ o (Summary)
4789@findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
4790(Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
4791originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that
4792e.g. replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
4793parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
4794function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
2b968687 4795article file name as a fallback method.
e6d2d263
MB
4796
4797@item $ u
4798@kindex $ u (Summary)
4799@findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
4800Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
4801(@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
4802tips and tricks}).
4803
4804@end table
4805
4806@node Propagating marks
4807@subsubsection Propagating marks
4808
4809First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
4810propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
4811the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
4812
030cca00 4813@uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
e6d2d263
MB
4814
4815You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
4816is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
4817marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
4818fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
4819be useful to you.
4820
4821With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
4822alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
4823example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
4824into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
4825@samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
4826all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
4827create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
4828can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
4829implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
4830groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
4831
4832There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
2b968687 4833@samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
e6d2d263
MB
4834``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
4835search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
4836enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
2b968687 4837marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
e6d2d263
MB
4838mail group it will be still shown as unread.
4839
4840You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
4841tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
4842created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
4843@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
4844shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
4845even more cumbersome.
4846
4847Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
4848automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
4849@emph{marks propagation} is about.
4850
4851Marks propagation is deactivated by default. You can activate it for a
4852certain @code{nnmairix} group with
4853@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
4854p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
4855search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
4856temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
4857this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
4858
4859With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
4860group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
4861you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
4862magically be set for the original article, too.
4863
4864A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
4865
4866@vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
4867Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
4868not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
4869dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
4870will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
4871via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
4872details).
4873
4874Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
4875article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
4876the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
4877fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
4878marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
4879set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
4880the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
4881
4882@vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
4883If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
2b968687
MB
4884original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
4885search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
4886way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
4887marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
4888setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
e6d2d263
MB
4889
4890Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e. if you
4891tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
4892article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
4893reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
4894immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
4895@code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
4896not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
4897groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
4898maildir as its file format.
4899
4900@vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
4901If you work with this setup, just set
4902@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
4903happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
4904problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
4905usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
4906groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
4907back end using @kbd{G b d}.
4908
4909@node nnmairix tips and tricks
4910@subsubsection nnmairix tips and tricks
4911
4912@itemize
4913@item
4914Checking Mail
4915
4916@findex nnmairix-update-groups
4917I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
4918have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
4919Levels}).
4920
4921I use the following to check for mails:
4922
4923@lisp
4924(defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
4925 (interactive "P")
4926 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
4927 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
4928 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
4929 (gnus-group-list-groups))
4930
4931(define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
4932@end lisp
4933
4934Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
4935server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
4936details.
4937
4938@item
4939Example: search group for ticked articles
4940
4941For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
4942articles always stay unread:
4943
4944Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g. @samp{important}), use
4945@samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
4946
4947Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
4948activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
4949
2b968687 4950So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
e6d2d263
MB
4951group? There are two options: You may simply use
4952@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
4953tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
4954@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
4955comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
4956also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
4957e.g. by marking an article as read.
4958
4959When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
4960article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
4961mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
4962for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
4963snippet and the doc string for details.
4964
4965@item
4966Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
4967
4968As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
4969the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
4970see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
4971should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
2b968687 4972usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
e6d2d263
MB
4973@code{nnml}, i.e. you will suddenly see groups of the form
4974@samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
4975simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
4976auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
4977@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
4978Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
4979for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
4980
4981@lisp
4982(setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
4983 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
4984@end lisp
4985
4986@end itemize
4987
4988@node nnmairix caveats
4989@subsubsection nnmairix caveats
4990
4991@itemize
4992@item
030cca00
MB
4993You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
4994you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
4995@code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
4996put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
4997an example server definition:
4998
4999@lisp
5000(nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
5001@end lisp
5002
5003(The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variabe
5004@code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
5005have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
5006mairix.)
e6d2d263
MB
5007
5008@item
5009If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
5010@code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
2b968687
MB
5011@code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}). Be @emph{extra careful} if
5012you use @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are
e6d2d263
MB
5013split into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as
5014you check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
5015
5016@item
2b968687 5017Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
e6d2d263
MB
5018groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
5019
030cca00
MB
5020@item
5021If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
5022@code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
5023
e6d2d263
MB
5024@item
5025mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
5026
5027@item
5028@code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
5029completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
2b968687 5030called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
e6d2d263
MB
5031back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
5032don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
5033own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
5034folders.
5035
5036@item
5037All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
5038(@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
5039is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
5040it is gone for good.
5041
5042@item
5043@findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
5044If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
5045``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
5046delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
5047@code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
5048save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
5049@code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
5050@code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
5051@code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
5052
5053@item
2b968687 5054The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
e6d2d263
MB
5055for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
5056
5057A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
5058comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
5059@samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
5060file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
5061update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
5062mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
5063while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
5064@samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
5065after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
5066non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
5067``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
5068to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
5069
5070@end itemize
5071
4009494e
GM
5072@node Misc Group Stuff
5073@section Misc Group Stuff
5074
5075@menu
5076* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
5077* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
5078* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
5079* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
5080* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
5081@end menu
5082
5083@table @kbd
5084
5085@item v
5086@kindex v (Group)
5087@cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
5088The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
5089command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
5090
5091@lisp
5092(define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
5093 (lambda ()
5094 (interactive)
5095 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
5096@end lisp
5097
5098On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
5099@xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
5100
5101@item ^
5102@kindex ^ (Group)
5103@findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
5104Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
5105@xref{Server Buffer}.
5106
5107@item a
5108@kindex a (Group)
5109@findex gnus-group-post-news
5110Start composing a message (a news by default)
5111(@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
5112under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5113Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
5114article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
5115with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
5116
5117@item m
5118@kindex m (Group)
5119@findex gnus-group-mail
5120Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
5121use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
5122prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5123@xref{Composing Messages}.
5124
5125@item i
5126@kindex i (Group)
5127@findex gnus-group-news
5128Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
5129post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
5130for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
5131
5132This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5133This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5134sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5135in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5136for this to work though.
5137
01c52d31
MB
5138@item G z
5139@kindex G z (Group)
5140@findex gnus-group-compact-group
5141
5142Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
5143Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
5144gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
5145count.
5146
4009494e
GM
5147@end table
5148
5149Variables for the group buffer:
5150
5151@table @code
5152
5153@item gnus-group-mode-hook
5154@vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
5155is called after the group buffer has been
5156created.
5157
5158@item gnus-group-prepare-hook
5159@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
5160is called after the group buffer is
5161generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
5162unnatural way.
5163
5164@item gnus-group-prepared-hook
5165@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
5166is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
5167generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
5168
5169@item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
5170@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
5171Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
5172whether they are empty or not.
5173
4009494e
GM
5174@end table
5175
5176@node Scanning New Messages
5177@subsection Scanning New Messages
5178@cindex new messages
5179@cindex scanning new news
5180
5181@table @kbd
5182
5183@item g
5184@kindex g (Group)
5185@findex gnus-group-get-new-news
5186@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
5187Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
5188this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
5189(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
5190command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
5191back end(s).
5192
5193@item M-g
5194@kindex M-g (Group)
5195@findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
5196@vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
5197@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
5198Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
5199(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
5200@code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
5201to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
5202
5203@findex gnus-activate-all-groups
5204@cindex activating groups
5205@item C-c M-g
5206@kindex C-c M-g (Group)
5207Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
5208
5209@item R
5210@kindex R (Group)
5211@cindex restarting
5212@findex gnus-group-restart
5213Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
5214file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
5215Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
5216
5217@end table
5218
5219@vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
5220@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
5221
5222@vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
5223@code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
5224news.
5225
5226
5227@node Group Information
5228@subsection Group Information
5229@cindex group information
5230@cindex information on groups
5231
5232@table @kbd
5233
5234
5235@item H f
5236@kindex H f (Group)
5237@findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
5238@vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
5239@cindex FAQ
5240@cindex ange-ftp
5241Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
5242(@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
5243from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
5244a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
5245In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
5246between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
5247used for fetching the file.
5248
5249If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
5250through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
5251
5252@item H c
5253@kindex H c (Group)
5254@findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
5255@vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
5256@cindex charter
5257Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
5258(@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
5259prefix argument.
5260
5261Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
5262the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
5263messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
5264
5265@item H C
5266@kindex H C (Group)
5267@findex gnus-group-fetch-control
5268@vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
5269@cindex control message
5270Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
5271@code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
5272group if given a prefix argument.
5273
5274If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
5275Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
5276@code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
5277and displayed in an ephemeral group.
5278
5279Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
5280you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
5281Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
5282
5283@item H d
5284@itemx C-c C-d
5285@c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
5286@kindex H d (Group)
5287@kindex C-c C-d (Group)
5288@cindex describing groups
5289@cindex group description
5290@findex gnus-group-describe-group
5291Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
5292a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
5293
5294@item M-d
5295@kindex M-d (Group)
5296@findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
5297Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
5298prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
5299
5300@item H v
5301@itemx V
5302@kindex V (Group)
5303@kindex H v (Group)
5304@cindex version
5305@findex gnus-version
5306Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
5307
5308@item ?
5309@kindex ? (Group)
5310@findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
5311Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
5312
5313@item C-c C-i
5314@kindex C-c C-i (Group)
5315@cindex info
5316@cindex manual
5317@findex gnus-info-find-node
5318Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
5319@end table
5320
5321
5322@node Group Timestamp
5323@subsection Group Timestamp
5324@cindex timestamps
5325@cindex group timestamps
5326
5327It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
5328group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
5329@code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
5330
5331@lisp
5332(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
5333@end lisp
5334
5335After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
5336
5337This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
5338use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
5339
5340@lisp
5341(setq gnus-group-line-format
5342 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
5343@end lisp
5344
5345This will result in lines looking like:
5346
5347@example
5348* 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
5349 0: custom 19961002T012713
5350@end example
5351
5352As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
5353may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
5354something like:
5355
5356@lisp
5357(setq gnus-group-line-format
5358 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
5359@end lisp
5360
5361If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
5362user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
5363trick:
5364
5365@lisp
5366(setq gnus-group-line-format
5367 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
5368(defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
5369 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
5370 (if time
5371 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
5372 "")))
5373@end lisp
5374
5375
5376@node File Commands
5377@subsection File Commands
5378@cindex file commands
5379
5380@table @kbd
5381
5382@item r
5383@kindex r (Group)
5384@findex gnus-group-read-init-file
5385@vindex gnus-init-file
5386@cindex reading init file
5387Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
5388@file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
5389
5390@item s
5391@kindex s (Group)
5392@findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
5393@cindex saving .newsrc
5394Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
5395(@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
5396file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
5397
5398@c @item Z
5399@c @kindex Z (Group)
5400@c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
5401@c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
5402
5403@end table
5404
5405
5406@node Sieve Commands
5407@subsection Sieve Commands
5408@cindex group sieve commands
5409
5410Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
5411the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
5412sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
5413commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
5414script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
5415
5416@vindex gnus-sieve-file
5417@vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
5418@vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
5419The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
5420default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
5421between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
5422@code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
5423outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
5424regenerate the Sieve script.
5425
5426@vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
5427The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
5428is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
5429placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
5430is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
5431example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
5432"owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
5433code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
5434@code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
5435except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
5436
5437@example
5438if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
5439 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
5440 stop;
5441@}
5442@end example
5443
5444@xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
5445
5446@table @kbd
5447
5448@item D g
5449@kindex D g (Group)
5450@findex gnus-sieve-generate
5451@vindex gnus-sieve-file
5452@cindex generating sieve script
5453Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
5454put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
5455
5456@item D u
5457@kindex D u (Group)
5458@findex gnus-sieve-update
5459@vindex gnus-sieve-file
5460@cindex updating sieve script
5461Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
5462@code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
5463server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
5464
5465@end table
5466
5467
5468@node Summary Buffer
5469@chapter Summary Buffer
5470@cindex summary buffer
5471
5472A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
5473move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
5474
5475The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
5476group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
5477
5478You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
5479
5480You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
5481customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
5482available in Emacs.
5483
5484@kindex v (Summary)
5485@cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
5486The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
5487command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
5488@lisp
5489(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
5490@end lisp
5491
5492@menu
5493* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
5494* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
5495* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
5496* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
5497* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
5498* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
5499* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
5500* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
5501* Threading:: How threads are made.
5502* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
5503* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
5504* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
5505* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
01c52d31 5506* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4009494e
GM
5507* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
5508* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
5509* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
5510* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
5511* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
5512* Charsets:: Character set issues.
5513* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
5514* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
5515* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
5516* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
5517* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
5518* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
5519* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
5520* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
5521 or reselecting the current group.
5522* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
5523* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
5524* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
5525* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
5526@end menu
5527
5528
5529@node Summary Buffer Format
5530@section Summary Buffer Format
5531@cindex summary buffer format
5532
5533@iftex
5534@iflatex
5535\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
5536\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
5537\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
5538}
5539@end iflatex
5540@end iftex
5541
5542@menu
5543* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
5544* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
5545* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
5546* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
5547@end menu
5548
5549@findex mail-extract-address-components
5550@findex gnus-extract-address-components
5551@vindex gnus-extract-address-components
5552Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
5553variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
5554@code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
5555@code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
5556fast, and too simplistic solution; and
5557@code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
5558slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
5559cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
5560
5561@lisp
5562(setq gnus-extract-address-components
5563 'mail-extract-address-components)
5564@end lisp
5565
5566@vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
5567@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
5568article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
5569with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
5570
5571
5572@node Summary Buffer Lines
5573@subsection Summary Buffer Lines
5574
5575@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5576You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
5577the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
5578lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
5579(@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
5580
5581There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
5582the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
5583performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
5584possible to change this. Just write a new function
5585@code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
5586@xref{Positioning Point}.
5587
5588The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
5589
5590The following format specification characters and extended format
5591specification(s) are understood:
5592
5593@table @samp
5594@item N
5595Article number.
5596@item S
5597Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
5598@code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
5599@item s
5600Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
5601had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
5602(@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
5603@item F
5604Full @code{From} header.
5605@item n
5606The name (from the @code{From} header).
5607@item f
5608The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
5609From Newsgroups}).
5610@item a
5611The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
5612spec in that it uses the function designated by the
5613@code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
5614may be more thorough.
5615@item A
5616The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
5617the @code{a} spec.
5618@item L
5619Number of lines in the article.
5620@item c
5621Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
5622in some methods (like nnfolder).
5623@item k
5624Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
5625for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
5626@item I
5627Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
5628@item B
5629A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
5630lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
5631
5632@example
5633>
5634+->
5635| +->
5636| | \->
5637| | \->
5638| \->
5639+->
5640\->
5641@end example
5642
5643You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
5644that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
5645replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
5646line-drawing glyphs.
5647@table @code
5648@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
5649@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
5650Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
5651instead. The default is @samp{> }.
5652
5653@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
5654@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
5655Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
5656@code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
5657
5658@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
5659@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
5660Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
5661instead. The default is @samp{}.
5662
5663@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
5664@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
5665Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
5666
5667@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
5668@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
5669Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
5670
5671@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
5672@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
5673Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
5674
5675@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
5676@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
5677Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
5678
5679@end table
5680
5681@item T
5682Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
5683pushes everything after it off the screen).
5684@item [
5685Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
5686for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
5687@item ]
5688Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
5689for adopted articles.
5690@item >
5691One space for each thread level.
5692@item <
5693Twenty minus thread level spaces.
5694@item U
5695Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
5696
5697@item R
5698This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
5699mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
5700or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
5701
5702@item i
5703Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
5704@item z
5705@vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
5706Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
5707default level. If the difference between
5708@code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
5709@code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
5710@item V
5711Total thread score.
5712@item x
5713@code{Xref}.
5714@item D
5715@code{Date}.
5716@item d
5717The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
5718@item o
5719The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
5720@item M
5721@code{Message-ID}.
5722@item r
5723@code{References}.
5724@item t
5725Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
5726down summary buffer generation somewhat.
5727@item e
5728An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
5729article has any children.
5730@item P
5731The line number.
5732@item O
5733Download mark.
5734@item *
5735Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
5736@item &user-date;
5737Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
5738@code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
5739@item u
5740User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
5741be a letter. Gnus will call the function
5742@code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
5743following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
5744argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
5745into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
5746@end table
5747
5748Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
5749@code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
5750There can only be one such area.
5751
5752The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
5753have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
5754compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
5755that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
5756variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
5757buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
5758
5759The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
5760(Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
5761
5762This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
5763
5764
5765@node To From Newsgroups
5766@subsection To From Newsgroups
5767@cindex To
5768@cindex Newsgroups
5769
5770In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
5771isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5772you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5773headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5774gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
5775
5776@enumerate
5777@item
5778@vindex gnus-extra-headers
5779The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5780@code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5781instance:
5782
5783@lisp
5784(setq gnus-extra-headers
5785 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5786@end lisp
5787
5788This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5789storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5790
5791@item
5792@findex gnus-extra-header
5793The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5794@code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5795access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5796
5797@example
5798"%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5799@end example
5800
5801@item
5802@vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5803The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5804summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5805@code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5806@code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5807headers are used instead.
5808
01c52d31
MB
5809To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5810has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5811@code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5812@samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5813customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5814@code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5815
4009494e
GM
5816@end enumerate
5817
5818@vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5819A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5820to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5821If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5822changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5823and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
5824regeneration.
5825
5826@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5827You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5828@code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5829@code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5830
5831In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5832@file{~/.gnus.el}:
5833
5834@lisp
5835(setq gnus-extra-headers
5836 '(To Newsgroups))
5837(setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5838(setq gnus-summary-line-format
5839 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5840(setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5841 "Your Name Here")
5842@end lisp
5843
5844(The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5845to fit your needs.)
5846
5847A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5848convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5849support:
5850
5851The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5852the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5853nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5854
5855@example
5856Newsgroups:full
5857@end example
5858
5859to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5860as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5861
5862
5863@node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5864@subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5865
5866@vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5867You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5868Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5869like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5870
5871Here are the elements you can play with:
5872
5873@table @samp
5874@item G
5875Group name.
5876@item p
5877Unprefixed group name.
5878@item A
5879Current article number.
5880@item z
5881Current article score.
5882@item V
5883Gnus version.
5884@item U
5885Number of unread articles in this group.
5886@item e
5887Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5888summary buffer.
5889@item Z
5890A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5891either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5892articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5893and no unselected ones.
5894@item g
5895Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5896shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5897@item S
5898Subject of the current article.
5899@item u
5900User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5901@item s
5902Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5903@item d
5904Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5905@item t
5906Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5907@item r
5908Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5909@item E
5910Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5911@end table
5912
5913
5914@node Summary Highlighting
5915@subsection Summary Highlighting
5916
5917@table @code
5918
5919@item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5920@vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5921This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5922highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5923@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5924
5925@item gnus-summary-update-hook
5926@vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5927This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5928@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5929
5930@item gnus-summary-selected-face
5931@vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5932This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5933highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5934
5935@item gnus-summary-highlight
5936@vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5937Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5938list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5939. @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5940italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5941to something like
5942@lisp
5943(((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5944 ((> score default) . bold))
5945@end lisp
5946As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5947@var{face} will be applied to the line.
5948@end table
5949
5950
5951@node Summary Maneuvering
5952@section Summary Maneuvering
5953@cindex summary movement
5954
5955All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5956behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5957
5958None of these commands select articles.
5959
5960@table @kbd
5961@item G M-n
5962@itemx M-n
5963@kindex M-n (Summary)
5964@kindex G M-n (Summary)
5965@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5966Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5967(@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5968
5969@item G M-p
5970@itemx M-p
5971@kindex M-p (Summary)
5972@kindex G M-p (Summary)
5973@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5974Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5975(@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5976
5977@item G g
5978@kindex G g (Summary)
5979@findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5980Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5981without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5982@end table
5983
5984If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5985can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5986buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5987to the group buffer.
5988
5989Variables related to summary movement:
5990
5991@table @code
5992
5993@vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5994@item gnus-auto-select-next
5995If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5996no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5997the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5998empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5999this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
6000next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
6001is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
6002confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
6003will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
6004Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
6005command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
6006@pxref{Group Levels}.
6007
6008@item gnus-auto-select-same
6009@vindex gnus-auto-select-same
6010If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
6011article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
6012mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
6013for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
6014articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
6015
6016This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
6017
6018@item gnus-summary-check-current
6019@vindex gnus-summary-check-current
6020If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
6021to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
6022Instead, they will choose the current article.
6023
6024@item gnus-auto-center-summary
6025@vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
6026If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
6027centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
6028slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
6029set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
6030action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
6031buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
6032threads.
6033
6034This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
6035the given number of lines from the top.
6036
6037@end table
6038
6039
6040@node Choosing Articles
6041@section Choosing Articles
6042@cindex selecting articles
6043
6044@menu
6045* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
6046* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
6047@end menu
6048
6049
6050@node Choosing Commands
6051@subsection Choosing Commands
6052
6053None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
6054and they all select and display an article.
6055
6056If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
6057@ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
6058
6059@table @kbd
6060@item SPACE
6061@kindex SPACE (Summary)
6062@findex gnus-summary-next-page
6063Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
6064unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
6065
6066If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
6067again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
6068@kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
6069
6070@item G n
6071@itemx n
6072@kindex n (Summary)
6073@kindex G n (Summary)
6074@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
6075@c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
6076Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
6077
6078@item G p
6079@itemx p
6080@kindex p (Summary)
6081@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
6082@c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
6083Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
6084
6085@item G N
6086@itemx N
6087@kindex N (Summary)
6088@kindex G N (Summary)
6089@findex gnus-summary-next-article
6090Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
6091
6092@item G P
6093@itemx P
6094@kindex P (Summary)
6095@kindex G P (Summary)
6096@findex gnus-summary-prev-article
6097Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
6098
6099@item G C-n
6100@kindex G C-n (Summary)
6101@findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
6102Go to the next article with the same subject
6103(@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
6104
6105@item G C-p
6106@kindex G C-p (Summary)
6107@findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
6108Go to the previous article with the same subject
6109(@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
6110
6111@item G f
6112@itemx .
6113@kindex G f (Summary)
6114@kindex . (Summary)
6115@findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
6116Go to the first unread article
6117(@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
6118
6119@item G b
6120@itemx ,
6121@kindex G b (Summary)
6122@kindex , (Summary)
6123@findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
6124Go to the unread article with the highest score
6125(@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
6126go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
6127
6128@item G l
6129@itemx l
6130@kindex l (Summary)
6131@kindex G l (Summary)
6132@findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
6133Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
6134
6135@item G o
6136@kindex G o (Summary)
6137@findex gnus-summary-pop-article
6138@cindex history
6139@cindex article history
6140Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
6141(@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
6142command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
6143history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
6144For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
6145@pxref{Article Backlog}.
6146
6147@item G j
6148@itemx j
6149@kindex j (Summary)
6150@kindex G j (Summary)
6151@findex gnus-summary-goto-article
6152Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
6153article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
6154
6155@end table
6156
6157
6158@node Choosing Variables
6159@subsection Choosing Variables
6160
6161Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
6162
6163@table @code
6164@item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
6165@vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
6166All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
6167article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
6168this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
6169the server and display it in the article buffer.
6170
6171@item gnus-select-article-hook
6172@vindex gnus-select-article-hook
6173This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
6174@code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
6175you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
6176hook will do so.
6177
6178@item gnus-mark-article-hook
6179@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
6180@findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
6181@findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
6182@findex gnus-unread-mark
6183This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
6184be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
6185@code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
6186mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
6187articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
6188expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
6189marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
6190instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
6191@code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
6192
6193@end table
6194
6195
6196@node Paging the Article
6197@section Scrolling the Article
6198@cindex article scrolling
6199
6200@table @kbd
6201
6202@item SPACE
6203@kindex SPACE (Summary)
6204@findex gnus-summary-next-page
6205Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
6206or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
6207next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
6208
6209@vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
6210@vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
6211If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
6212the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
6213skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
6214what is considered uninteresting with
6215@code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
6216pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
6217
6218@item DEL
6219@kindex DEL (Summary)
6220@findex gnus-summary-prev-page
6221Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
6222
6223@item RET
6224@kindex RET (Summary)
6225@findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
6226Scroll the current article one line forward
6227(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
6228
6229@item M-RET
6230@kindex M-RET (Summary)
6231@findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
6232Scroll the current article one line backward
6233(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
6234
6235@item A g
6236@itemx g
6237@kindex A g (Summary)
6238@kindex g (Summary)
6239@findex gnus-summary-show-article
6240@vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
6241(Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
6242given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
6243article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
6244the way it came from the server.
6245
e3e955fe 6246@cindex charset, view article with different charset
4009494e
GM
6247If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
6248@kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
6249encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
6250
6251@lisp
6252(setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
6253 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
6254 (2 . big5)))
6255@end lisp
6256
6257then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
6258
6259@item A <
6260@itemx <
6261@kindex < (Summary)
6262@kindex A < (Summary)
6263@findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
6264Scroll to the beginning of the article
6265(@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
6266
6267@item A >
6268@itemx >
6269@kindex > (Summary)
6270@kindex A > (Summary)
6271@findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
6272Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
6273
6274@item A s
6275@itemx s
6276@kindex A s (Summary)
6277@kindex s (Summary)
6278@findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
6279Perform an isearch in the article buffer
6280(@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
6281
6282@item h
6283@kindex h (Summary)
6284@findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
6285Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
6286
6287@end table
6288
6289
6290@node Reply Followup and Post
6291@section Reply, Followup and Post
6292
6293@menu
6294* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
6295* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
6296* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
6297* Canceling and Superseding::
6298@end menu
6299
6300
6301@node Summary Mail Commands
6302@subsection Summary Mail Commands
6303@cindex mail
6304@cindex composing mail
6305
6306Commands for composing a mail message:
6307
6308@table @kbd
6309
6310@item S r
6311@itemx r
6312@kindex S r (Summary)
6313@kindex r (Summary)
6314@findex gnus-summary-reply
6315@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
6316@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
6317Mail a reply to the author of the current article
6318(@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
6319
6320@item S R
6321@itemx R
6322@kindex R (Summary)
6323@kindex S R (Summary)
6324@findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
6325@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
6326Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
6327original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
6328command uses the process/prefix convention.
6329
6330@item S w
6331@kindex S w (Summary)
6332@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
6333Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
6334(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
6335goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
6336@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
6337present, that's used instead.
6338
6339@item S W
6340@kindex S W (Summary)
6341@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
6342Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
6343message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
6344the process/prefix convention.
6345
6346@item S v
6347@kindex S v (Summary)
6348@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
6349Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
6350(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
6351that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
6352@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
6353articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
6354
6355@item S V
6356@kindex S V (Summary)
6357@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
6358Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
6359original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
6360command uses the process/prefix convention.
6361
6362@item S B r
6363@kindex S B r (Summary)
6364@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
6365Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
6366@code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
6367If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
6368@code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
6369the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
6370correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
6371
6372@item S B R
6373@kindex S B R (Summary)
6374@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
6375Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
6376original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
6377(@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
6378
6379@item S o m
6380@itemx C-c C-f
6381@kindex S o m (Summary)
6382@kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
6383@findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
6384@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
6385Forward the current article to some other person
6386(@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
6387is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
6388and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
6389message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
6390as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
6391forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
6392directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
6393but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
6394default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
6395section.
6396
6397@item S m
6398@itemx m
6399@kindex m (Summary)
6400@kindex S m (Summary)
6401@findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
6402@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
6403Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
6404the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
6405If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
6406
6407@item S i
6408@itemx i
6409@kindex i (Summary)
6410@kindex S i (Summary)
6411@findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
6412Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
6413post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
6414prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
6415
6416This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
6417This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
6418sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
6419in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
6420for this to work though.
6421
6422@item S D b
6423@kindex S D b (Summary)
6424@findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
6425@cindex bouncing mail
6426If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
6427reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
6428resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
6429will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
6430sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
6431the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
6432that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
6433very well fail, though.
6434
6435@item S D r
6436@kindex S D r (Summary)
6437@findex gnus-summary-resend-message
6438Not to be confused with the previous command,
6439@code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
6440send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
6441headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
6442@code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
6443means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
6444header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
6445So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
6446
6447This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
6448ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
6449@code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
6450to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
6451@code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
6452
6453This command understands the process/prefix convention
6454(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6455
6456@item S D e
6457@kindex S D e (Summary)
6458@findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
6459
6460Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
6461if it were a new message before resending.
6462
6463@item S O m
6464@kindex S O m (Summary)
6465@findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
6466Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
6467result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
6468uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6469
6470@item S M-c
6471@kindex S M-c (Summary)
6472@findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
6473@cindex crossposting
6474@cindex excessive crossposting
6475Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
6476current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
6477
6478@findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
6479This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
6480crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
6481using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
6482command understands the process/prefix convention
6483(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
6484
6485@end table
6486
6487Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
6488Manual}, for more information.
6489
6490
6491@node Summary Post Commands
6492@subsection Summary Post Commands
6493@cindex post
6494@cindex composing news
6495
6496Commands for posting a news article:
6497
6498@table @kbd
6499@item S p
6500@itemx a
6501@kindex a (Summary)
6502@kindex S p (Summary)
6503@findex gnus-summary-post-news
6504@c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
6505Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
6506default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
6507If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
6508
6509@item S f
6510@itemx f
6511@kindex f (Summary)
6512@kindex S f (Summary)
6513@findex gnus-summary-followup
6514@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
6515Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
6516
6517@item S F
6518@itemx F
6519@kindex S F (Summary)
6520@kindex F (Summary)
6521@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
6522@findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
6523Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
6524(@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
6525process/prefix convention.
6526
6527@item S n
6528@kindex S n (Summary)
6529@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
6530Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
6531message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
6532
6533@item S N
6534@kindex S N (Summary)
6535@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
6536Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
6537message through mail and include the original message
6538(@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
6539the process/prefix convention.
6540
6541@item S o p
6542@kindex S o p (Summary)
6543@findex gnus-summary-post-forward
6544Forward the current article to a newsgroup
6545(@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
6546 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
6547of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
6548(@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
6549message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
6550as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
6551forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
6552directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
6553but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
6554default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
6555
6556@item S O p
6557@kindex S O p (Summary)
6558@findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
6559@cindex digests
6560@cindex making digests
6561Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
6562(@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
6563process/prefix convention.
6564
6565@item S u
6566@kindex S u (Summary)
6567@findex gnus-uu-post-news
6568@c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
6569Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
6570(@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
6571@end table
6572
6573Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
6574Manual}, for more information.
6575
6576
6577@node Summary Message Commands
6578@subsection Summary Message Commands
6579
6580@table @kbd
6581@item S y
6582@kindex S y (Summary)
6583@findex gnus-summary-yank-message
6584Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
6585buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
6586what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
6587process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6588
6589@end table
6590
6591
6592@node Canceling and Superseding
6593@subsection Canceling Articles
6594@cindex canceling articles
6595@cindex superseding articles
6596
6597Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
6598really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
6599
6600Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
6601
6602@findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
6603@kindex C (Summary)
6604@c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
6605Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
6606articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
6607c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
6608canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
6609This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6610
6611Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
6612live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
6613question.
6614
6615Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
6616want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
6617prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
6618
6619Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
6620@code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
6621message, Message Manual}).
6622
6623If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
6624corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
6625your original article.
6626
6627@findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
6628@kindex S (Summary)
6629Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
6630(@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
6631where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
6632usual way.
6633
6634The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
6635sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
6636have posted almost the same article twice.
6637
6638If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
6639there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
6640waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
6641to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
6642find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
6643the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
6644header by substituting one of those words for the word
6645@code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
6646you would do normally. The previous article will be
6647canceled/superseded.
6648
6649Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
6650
6651@node Delayed Articles
6652@section Delayed Articles
6653@cindex delayed sending
6654@cindex send delayed
6655
6656Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
6657example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
6658to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
6659there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
6660
6661@lisp
6662(gnus-delay-initialize)
6663@end lisp
6664
6665@findex gnus-delay-article
6666Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
6667Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
6668(@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
6669message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
6670
6671@itemize @bullet
6672@item
6673A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
6674@code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
6675(minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
6676(months) and @code{Y} (years).
6677
6678@item
6679A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
6680delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
6681See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
6682
6683@item
6684A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
6685stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
6686already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
6687o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
6688is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
6689that means a time tomorrow.
6690@end itemize
6691
6692The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
6693couple of variables:
6694
6695@table @code
6696@item gnus-delay-default-hour
6697@vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
6698When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
6699on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
6700
6701@item gnus-delay-default-delay
6702@vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
6703This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
6704formats described above.
6705
6706@item gnus-delay-group
6707@vindex gnus-delay-group
6708Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
6709they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
6710value is @code{"delayed"}.
6711
6712@item gnus-delay-header
6713@vindex gnus-delay-header
6714The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
6715is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
6716change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
6717@end table
6718
6719The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
6720@code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
6721calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
6722@code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
6723@code{nndraft:delayed} group.
6724
6725@findex gnus-delay-send-queue
6726And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
6727which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
6728function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
6729@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
6730Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
6731execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
6732
6733@table @code
6734@item gnus-delay-initialize
6735@findex gnus-delay-initialize
6736By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
6737@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
6738argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
6739@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
6740argument is ignored.
6741
6742For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
6743Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
6744Just don't forget to set that up :-)
6745@end table
6746
6747
6748@node Marking Articles
6749@section Marking Articles
6750@cindex article marking
6751@cindex article ticking
6752@cindex marks
6753
6754There are several marks you can set on an article.
6755
6756You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6757neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6758@dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
6759
6760In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
6761
6762@ifinfo
6763There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6764@end ifinfo
6765
6766@menu
6767* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6768* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6769* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6770* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6771* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6772* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6773@end menu
6774
6775
6776@node Unread Articles
6777@subsection Unread Articles
6778
6779The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6780other.
6781
6782@table @samp
6783@item !
6784@vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6785Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6786
6787@dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6788you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6789reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6790tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6791news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6792you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6793(@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6794
6795@item ?
6796@vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6797Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6798
6799@dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6800are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6801followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6802Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6803messages.
6804
6805@item SPACE
6806@vindex gnus-unread-mark
6807Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6808
6809@dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6810@end table
6811
6812
6813@node Read Articles
6814@subsection Read Articles
6815@cindex expirable mark
6816
6817All the following marks mark articles as read.
6818
6819@table @samp
6820
6821@item r
6822@vindex gnus-del-mark
6823These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6824command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6825
6826@item R
6827@vindex gnus-read-mark
6828Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6829
6830@item O
6831@vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6832Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6833@dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6834
6835@item K
6836@vindex gnus-killed-mark
6837Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6838
6839@item X
6840@vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6841Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6842
6843@item Y
6844@vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6845Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6846
6847@item C
6848@vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6849Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6850
6851@item G
6852@vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6853Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6854
6855@item F
6856@vindex gnus-souped-mark
6857@sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
6858
6859@item Q
6860@vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6861Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6862Threading}.
6863
6864@item M
6865@vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6866Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6867(@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6868
6869@end table
6870
6871All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6872They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6873
6874One more special mark, though:
6875
6876@table @samp
6877@item E
6878@vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6879Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6880
6881Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6882automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6883control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6884articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6885any time.
6886@end table
6887
6888
6889@node Other Marks
6890@subsection Other Marks
6891@cindex process mark
6892@cindex bookmarks
6893
6894There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6895read or not.
6896
6897@itemize @bullet
6898
6899@item
6900You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6901long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6902before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6903in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6904encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6905
6906@item
6907@vindex gnus-replied-mark
6908All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6909answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6910(@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6911
6912@item
6913@vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6914All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6915the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6916
6917@item
6918@vindex gnus-cached-mark
6919Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6920the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6921
6922@item
6923@vindex gnus-saved-mark
6924Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6925religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6926(@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6927
6928@item
6929@vindex gnus-recent-mark
6930Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
6931before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
6932(@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
6933mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
6934@code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
6935
6936@item
6937@vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6938Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6939with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6940Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
6941
6942@item
6943@vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6944When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6945downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6946@samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6947(The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6948use.)
6949
6950@item
6951@vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6952When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6953not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6954are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6955articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6956@code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6957
6958@item
6959@vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6960The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6961automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6962download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6963explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6964(The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6965use.)
6966
6967@item
6968@vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6969@vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6970If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6971marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6972@code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6973
6974@item
6975@vindex gnus-process-mark
6976Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6977variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6978instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6979all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6980marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6981
6982@end itemize
6983
6984You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6985appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6986replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6987
6988Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6989replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6990you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6991
6992
6993@node Setting Marks
6994@subsection Setting Marks
6995@cindex setting marks
6996
6997All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6998
6999@table @kbd
7000@item M c
7001@itemx M-u
7002@kindex M c (Summary)
7003@kindex M-u (Summary)
7004@findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
7005@cindex mark as unread
7006Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
7007(@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
7008article as unread.
7009
7010@item M t
7011@itemx !
7012@kindex ! (Summary)
7013@kindex M t (Summary)
7014@findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
7015Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
7016@xref{Article Caching}.
7017
7018@item M ?
7019@itemx ?
7020@kindex ? (Summary)
7021@kindex M ? (Summary)
7022@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
7023Mark the current article as dormant
7024(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
7025
7026@item M d
7027@itemx d
7028@kindex M d (Summary)
7029@kindex d (Summary)
7030@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
7031Mark the current article as read
7032(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
7033
7034@item D
7035@kindex D (Summary)
7036@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
7037Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
7038(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
7039
7040@item M k
7041@itemx k
7042@kindex k (Summary)
7043@kindex M k (Summary)
7044@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
7045Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
7046and then select the next unread article
7047(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
7048
7049@item M K
7050@itemx C-k
7051@kindex M K (Summary)
7052@kindex C-k (Summary)
7053@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
7054Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
7055(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
7056
7057@item M C
7058@kindex M C (Summary)
7059@findex gnus-summary-catchup
7060@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
7061Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
7062
7063@item M C-c
7064@kindex M C-c (Summary)
7065@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
7066Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
7067articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
7068
7069@item M H
7070@kindex M H (Summary)
7071@findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
7072Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
7073(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
7074
7075@item M h
7076@kindex M h (Summary)
7077@findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
7078Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
7079(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
7080
7081@item C-w
7082@kindex C-w (Summary)
7083@findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
7084Mark all articles between point and mark as read
7085(@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
7086
7087@item M V k
7088@kindex M V k (Summary)
7089@findex gnus-summary-kill-below
7090Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
7091numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
7092
7093@item M e
7094@itemx E
7095@kindex M e (Summary)
7096@kindex E (Summary)
7097@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
7098Mark the current article as expirable
7099(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
7100
7101@item M b
7102@kindex M b (Summary)
7103@findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
7104Set a bookmark in the current article
7105(@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
7106
7107@item M B
7108@kindex M B (Summary)
7109@findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
7110Remove the bookmark from the current article
7111(@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
7112
7113@item M V c
7114@kindex M V c (Summary)
7115@findex gnus-summary-clear-above
7116Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
7117over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
7118
7119@item M V u
7120@kindex M V u (Summary)
7121@findex gnus-summary-tick-above
7122Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
7123numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
7124
7125@item M V m
7126@kindex M V m (Summary)
7127@findex gnus-summary-mark-above
7128Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
7129score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
7130(@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
7131@end table
7132
7133@vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
7134The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
7135be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
7136the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
7137one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
7138@code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
7139@kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
7140The default is @code{t}.
7141
7142
7143@node Generic Marking Commands
7144@subsection Generic Marking Commands
7145
7146Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
7147the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
7148article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
7149even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
7150previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
7151well.
7152
7153Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
7154you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
7155command should do.
7156
7157To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
7158different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
7159buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
7160to list in this manual.
7161
7162While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
7163altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
7164@kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
7165article, you could say something like:
7166
7167@lisp
7168@group
7169(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
7170(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
7171 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
7172@end group
7173@end lisp
7174
7175@noindent
7176or
7177
7178@lisp
7179(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
7180 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
7181@end lisp
7182
7183
7184@node Setting Process Marks
7185@subsection Setting Process Marks
7186@cindex setting process marks
7187
7188Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
7189used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
7190process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
7191articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
7192articles into the cache. For more information,
7193@pxref{Process/Prefix}.
7194
7195@table @kbd
7196
7197@item M P p
7198@itemx #
7199@kindex # (Summary)
7200@kindex M P p (Summary)
7201@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
7202Mark the current article with the process mark
7203(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
7204@findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
7205
7206@item M P u
7207@itemx M-#
7208@kindex M P u (Summary)
7209@kindex M-# (Summary)
7210Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
7211(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
7212
7213@item M P U
7214@kindex M P U (Summary)
7215@findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
7216Remove the process mark from all articles
7217(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
7218
7219@item M P i
7220@kindex M P i (Summary)
7221@findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
7222Invert the list of process marked articles
7223(@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
7224
7225@item M P R
7226@kindex M P R (Summary)
7227@findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
7228Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
7229expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
7230
7231@item M P G
7232@kindex M P G (Summary)
7233@findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
7234Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
7235expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
7236
7237@item M P r
7238@kindex M P r (Summary)
7239@findex gnus-uu-mark-region
7240Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
7241
7242@item M P g
7243@kindex M P g (Summary)
7244@findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
7245Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
7246
7247@item M P t
7248@kindex M P t (Summary)
7249@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7250Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
7251(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7252
7253@item M P T
7254@kindex M P T (Summary)
7255@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7256Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
7257(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7258
7259@item M P v
7260@kindex M P v (Summary)
7261@findex gnus-uu-mark-over
7262Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
7263(@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
7264
7265@item M P s
7266@kindex M P s (Summary)
7267@findex gnus-uu-mark-series
7268Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
7269
7270@item M P S
7271@kindex M P S (Summary)
7272@findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
7273Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
7274(@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
7275
7276@item M P a
7277@kindex M P a (Summary)
7278@findex gnus-uu-mark-all
7279Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
7280
7281@item M P b
7282@kindex M P b (Summary)
7283@findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
7284Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
7285(@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
7286
7287@item M P k
7288@kindex M P k (Summary)
7289@findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
7290Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
7291(@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
7292
7293@item M P y
7294@kindex M P y (Summary)
7295@findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
7296Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
7297(@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
7298
7299@item M P w
7300@kindex M P w (Summary)
7301@findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
7302Push the current process mark set onto the stack
7303(@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
7304
7305@end table
7306
7307Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
7308set process marks based on article body contents.
7309
7310
7311@node Limiting
7312@section Limiting
7313@cindex limiting
7314
7315It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
7316subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
7317commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
7318buffer.
7319
26b9f88d
MB
7320Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
7321the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
7322articles.
4009494e
GM
7323
7324@table @kbd
7325
7326@item / /
7327@itemx / s
7328@kindex / / (Summary)
7329@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
7330Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
7331(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
7332matching articles.
7333
7334@item / a
7335@kindex / a (Summary)
7336@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
7337Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
7338(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
7339matching articles.
7340
01c52d31
MB
7341@item / R
7342@kindex / R (Summary)
7343@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
7344Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
7345(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
7346matching articles.
7347
7348@item / A
7349@kindex / A (Summary)
7350@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
7351Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
7352header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
7353given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
7354
7355@item / S
7356@kindex / S (Summary)
7357@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
7358Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
7359threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
7360limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
7361
4009494e
GM
7362@item / x
7363@kindex / x (Summary)
7364@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
7365Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
7366headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
7367(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
7368matching articles.
7369
7370@item / u
7371@itemx x
7372@kindex / u (Summary)
7373@kindex x (Summary)
7374@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
7375Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
7376(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
7377buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
7378dormant articles will also be excluded.
7379
7380@item / m
7381@kindex / m (Summary)
7382@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
7383Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
7384with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
7385
7386@item / t
7387@kindex / t (Summary)
7388@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
7389Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
7390(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
7391articles younger than that number of days.
7392
7393@item / n
7394@kindex / n (Summary)
7395@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
7396With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
7397articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
7398instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
7399
7400@item / w
7401@kindex / w (Summary)
7402@findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
7403Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
7404(@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
7405the stack.
7406
7407@item / .
7408@kindex / . (Summary)
7409@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
7410Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
7411(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
7412
7413@item / v
7414@kindex / v (Summary)
7415@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
7416Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
7417score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
7418
7419@item / p
7420@kindex / p (Summary)
7421@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
7422Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
7423group parameter predicate
7424(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
7425Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
7426
01c52d31
MB
7427@item / r
7428@kindex / r (Summary)
7429@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
7430Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
7431(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
7432replied articles.
7433
4009494e
GM
7434@item / E
7435@itemx M S
7436@kindex M S (Summary)
7437@kindex / E (Summary)
7438@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
7439Include all expunged articles in the limit
7440(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
7441
7442@item / D
7443@kindex / D (Summary)
7444@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
7445Include all dormant articles in the limit
7446(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
7447
7448@item / *
7449@kindex / * (Summary)
7450@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
7451Include all cached articles in the limit
7452(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
7453
7454@item / d
7455@kindex / d (Summary)
7456@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
7457Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
7458(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
7459
7460@item / M
7461@kindex / M (Summary)
7462@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
7463Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
7464
7465@item / T
7466@kindex / T (Summary)
7467@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
7468Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
7469
7470@item / c
7471@kindex / c (Summary)
7472@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
7473Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
7474(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
7475
7476@item / C
7477@kindex / C (Summary)
7478@findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
7479Mark all excluded unread articles as read
7480(@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
7481also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
7482
01c52d31
MB
7483@item / b
7484@kindex / b (Summary)
7485@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
7486Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
7487certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
7488prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
7489requires selecting each article to find the matches.
7490
7491@item / h
7492@kindex / h (Summary)
7493@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
7494Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
7495(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
7496
4009494e
GM
7497@end table
7498
7499
26b9f88d
MB
7500The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
7501prefix as well.
7502
7503@table @kbd
7504@item / N
7505@kindex / N (Summary)
7506@findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
7507Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
7508if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
7509
7510@item / o
7511@kindex / o (Summary)
7512@findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
7513Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
7514prefix, fetch this number of articles.
7515
7516@end table
7517
7518
4009494e
GM
7519@node Threading
7520@section Threading
7521@cindex threading
7522@cindex article threading
7523
7524Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
7525to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
7526hierarchical fashion.
7527
7528Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
7529articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
7530trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
7531or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
7532so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
7533plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
7534@ref{Customizing Threading}.
7535
7536First, a quick overview of the concepts:
7537
7538@table @dfn
7539@item root
7540The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
7541
7542@item thread
7543A tree-like article structure.
7544
7545@item sub-thread
7546A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
7547
7548@item loose threads
7549Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
7550already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
7551summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
7552belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
7553called loose threads.
7554
7555@item thread gathering
7556An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
7557
7558@item sparse threads
7559A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
7560displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
7561
7562@end table
7563
7564
7565@menu
7566* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
7567* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
7568@end menu
7569
7570
7571@node Customizing Threading
7572@subsection Customizing Threading
7573@cindex customizing threading
7574
7575@menu
7576* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
7577* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
7578* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
7579* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
7580@end menu
7581
7582
7583@node Loose Threads
7584@subsubsection Loose Threads
7585@cindex <
7586@cindex >
7587@cindex loose threads
7588
7589@table @code
7590@item gnus-summary-make-false-root
7591@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
7592If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
7593and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
7594Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
7595read or killed the root in a previous session.
7596
7597When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
7598something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
7599There are four possible values:
7600
7601@iftex
7602@iflatex
7603\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
7604\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
7605\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
7606\put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
7607\put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
7608}
7609@end iflatex
7610@end iftex
7611
7612@cindex adopting articles
7613
7614@table @code
7615
7616@item adopt
7617Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
7618parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
7619marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
7620square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
7621
7622@item dummy
7623@vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
7624@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
7625Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
7626parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
7627selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
7628article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
7629format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
7630which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
7631If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
7632ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
7633
7634@item empty
7635Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
7636subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
7637use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
7638Buffer Format}).)
7639
7640@item none
7641Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
7642display them after one another.
7643
7644@item nil
7645Don't gather loose threads.
7646@end table
7647
7648@item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
7649@vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
7650Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
7651variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
7652subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
7653super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
7654presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
7655you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
7656first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
7657variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
7658everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
7659
7660@cindex fuzzy article gathering
7661If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
7662use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
7663Matching}).
7664
7665@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
7666@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
7667This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
7668that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
7669simplification is used.
7670
7671@item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7672@vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7673If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
7674as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
7675
7676@c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
7677@lisp
7678(setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7679 (concat
7680 "\\`\\[?\\("
7681 (mapconcat
7682 'identity
7683 '("looking"
7684 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
7685 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
7686 "answer" "reference" "announce"
7687 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
7688 ;; ...
7689 )
7690 "\\|")
7691 "\\)\\s *\\("
7692 (mapconcat 'identity
7693 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
7694 "\\|")
7695 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
7696@end lisp
7697
7698All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
7699subjects.
7700
7701@item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
7702@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
7703If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
7704@code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
7705list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
7706arrive at the simplified version of the string.
7707
7708Useful functions to put in this list include:
7709
7710@table @code
7711@item gnus-simplify-subject-re
7712@findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
7713Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
7714
7715@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
7716@findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
7717Simplify fuzzily.
7718
7719@item gnus-simplify-whitespace
7720@findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
7721Remove excessive whitespace.
7722
7723@item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
7724@findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
7725Remove all whitespace.
7726@end table
7727
7728You may also write your own functions, of course.
7729
7730
7731@item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
7732@vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
7733Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
7734to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
7735@samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
7736you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
7737what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
7738The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
7739
7740@item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7741@vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7742Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
7743that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
7744is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
7745@code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
7746This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
7747articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
7748newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
7749cholera:
7750
7751@table @code
7752@item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7753@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7754This function is the default gathering function and looks at
7755@code{Subject}s exclusively.
7756
7757@item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7758@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7759This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
7760@end table
7761
7762If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
7763something like:
7764
7765@lisp
7766(setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7767 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7768@end lisp
7769
7770@end table
7771
7772
7773@node Filling In Threads
7774@subsubsection Filling In Threads
7775
7776@table @code
7777@item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7778@vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7779If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7780more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7781like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7782many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7783@code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7784number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7785old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7786files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7787@code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7788the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7789do about that.
7790
7791This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7792visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7793(@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7794
f394fa25
MB
7795The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7796
7797@cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7798This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7799cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7800that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7801slow summary generation.
7802
4009494e
GM
7803@item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7804@vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7805Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7806newsgroups.
7807
7808@item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7809@vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7810Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7811gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7812the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7813together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7814@dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7815is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7816lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7817question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7818``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7819thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7820off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7821@code{nil} by default.
7822
7823@item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7824@vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7825This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7826intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7827quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7828go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7829web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
7830
7831If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7832@code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7833that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7834
7835@end table
7836
7837
7838@node More Threading
7839@subsubsection More Threading
7840
7841@table @code
7842@item gnus-show-threads
7843@vindex gnus-show-threads
7844If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7845the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7846off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7847slower and more awkward.
7848
7849@item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7850@vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7851If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7852generated.
7853
7854This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7855Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7856@code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7857
7858Here's an example:
7859
7860@lisp
7861(setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7862 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7863 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7864@end lisp
7865
7866(It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7867unread, but you get my drift.)
7868
7869
7870@item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7871@vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7872All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7873@code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7874expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7875threads are expunged.
7876
7877@item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7878@vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7879if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7880will be hidden.
7881
7882@item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7883@vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7884Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7885this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7886change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7887result in a new thread.
7888
7889@item gnus-thread-indent-level
7890@vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7891This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7892The default is 4.
7893
7894@item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7895@vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7896Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7897arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7898arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7899using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7900up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7901Setting this variable to an alternate value
7902(e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7903appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7904more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7905
7906@end table
7907
7908
7909@node Low-Level Threading
7910@subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7911
7912@table @code
7913
7914@item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7915@vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7916Hook run before parsing any headers.
7917
7918@item gnus-alter-header-function
7919@vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7920If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7921article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7922the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7923if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7924in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7925variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7926meaningful. Here's one example:
7927
7928@lisp
7929(setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7930
7931(defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7932 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7933 (when (string-match
7934 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7935 (mail-header-set-id
7936 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7937 header))))
7938@end lisp
7939
7940@end table
7941
7942
7943@node Thread Commands
7944@subsection Thread Commands
7945@cindex thread commands
7946
7947@table @kbd
7948
7949@item T k
7950@itemx C-M-k
7951@kindex T k (Summary)
7952@kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7953@findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7954Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7955(@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7956remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7957articles instead.
7958
7959@item T l
7960@itemx C-M-l
7961@kindex T l (Summary)
7962@kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7963@findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7964Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7965(@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7966
7967@item T i
7968@kindex T i (Summary)
7969@findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7970Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7971(@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7972
7973@item T #
7974@kindex T # (Summary)
7975@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7976Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7977(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7978
7979@item T M-#
7980@kindex T M-# (Summary)
7981@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7982Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7983(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7984
7985@item T T
7986@kindex T T (Summary)
7987@findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7988Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7989
7990@item T s
7991@kindex T s (Summary)
7992@findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7993Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7994(@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7995
7996@item T h
7997@kindex T h (Summary)
7998@findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7999Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
8000
8001@item T S
8002@kindex T S (Summary)
8003@findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
8004Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
8005
8006@item T H
8007@kindex T H (Summary)
8008@findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
8009Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
8010
8011@item T t
8012@kindex T t (Summary)
8013@findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
8014Re-thread the current article's thread
8015(@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
8016summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
8017
8018@item T ^
8019@kindex T ^ (Summary)
8020@findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
8021Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
8022(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
8023
01c52d31
MB
8024@item T M-^
8025@kindex T M-^ (Summary)
8026@findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
8027Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
8028(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
8029
4009494e
GM
8030@end table
8031
8032The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
8033understand the numeric prefix.
8034
8035@table @kbd
8036
8037@item T n
8038@kindex T n (Summary)
8039@itemx C-M-f
8040@kindex C-M-n (Summary)
8041@itemx M-down
8042@kindex M-down (Summary)
8043@findex gnus-summary-next-thread
8044Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
8045
8046@item T p
8047@kindex T p (Summary)
8048@itemx C-M-b
8049@kindex C-M-p (Summary)
8050@itemx M-up
8051@kindex M-up (Summary)
8052@findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
8053Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
8054
8055@item T d
8056@kindex T d (Summary)
8057@findex gnus-summary-down-thread
8058Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
8059
8060@item T u
8061@kindex T u (Summary)
8062@findex gnus-summary-up-thread
8063Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
8064
8065@item T o
8066@kindex T o (Summary)
8067@findex gnus-summary-top-thread
8068Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
8069@end table
8070
8071@vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
8072If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
8073threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
8074a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
8075wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
8076have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
8077you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
8078is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
8079when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
8080the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
8081operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
8082that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
8083Matching}).
8084
8085
8086@node Sorting the Summary Buffer
8087@section Sorting the Summary Buffer
8088
8089@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
8090@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
8091@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
8092@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
8093@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
01c52d31 8094@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
4009494e
GM
8095@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
8096@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
8097@vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
8098@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
8099@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
8100If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
8101setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
8102function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
8103@code{(not some-function)} elements.
8104
8105By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
8106predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
01c52d31
MB
8107@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
8108@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
8109@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
8110@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
4009494e
GM
8111@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
8112@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
8113@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
8114@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
8115
8116Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
8117thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
8118normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
8119
8120If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
8121last function in the list. You should probably always include
8122@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
8123functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
8124equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
8125ascending article order.
8126
8127If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
8128by number, you could do something like:
8129
8130@lisp
8131(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
8132 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
8133 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
8134 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
8135@end lisp
8136
8137The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
8138summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
8139alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
8140subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
8141which the articles arrived.
8142
8143If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
8144say something like:
8145
8146@lisp
8147(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
01c52d31 8148 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
4009494e
GM
8149 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
8150@end lisp
8151
8152@vindex gnus-thread-score-function
8153The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
8154@code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
8155functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
8156tickles your fancy.
8157
8158@findex gnus-article-sort-functions
8159@findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
6ecfe5c2 8160@findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
4009494e
GM
8161@findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
8162@findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
8163@findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
8164@findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
8165@findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
6ecfe5c2 8166@findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
4009494e
GM
8167If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
8168other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
8169variable. It is very similar to the
8170@code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
8171different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
8172predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
8173@code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
8174@code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
8175@code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
8176@code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
8177
8178If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
8179say something like:
8180
8181@lisp
8182(setq gnus-article-sort-functions
8183 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
8184 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
8185@end lisp
8186
01c52d31
MB
8187You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
8188@xref{Group Parameters}.
4009494e
GM
8189
8190
8191@node Asynchronous Fetching
8192@section Asynchronous Article Fetching
8193@cindex asynchronous article fetching
8194@cindex article pre-fetch
8195@cindex pre-fetch
8196
8197If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
8198network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
8199for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
8200article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
8201while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
8202
8203First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
8204article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
8205
8206Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
8207quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
8208know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
8209article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
8210connection is blocked.
8211
8212To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
8213connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
8214thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
8215extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
8216
8217Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
8218the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
8219loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
8220also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
8221extra connection.
8222
8223Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
8224you really want to.
8225
8226@vindex gnus-asynchronous
8227Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
8228happen automatically.
8229
8230@vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
8231You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
8232@code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
8233that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
8234the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
8235pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
8236@code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
8237
8238@vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
8239@findex gnus-async-unread-p
8240There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
8241articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
8242variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
8243function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
8244to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
8245returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
8246article data structure as the only parameter.
8247
8248If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
8249than 100 lines, you could say something like:
8250
8251@lisp
8252(defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
8253 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
8254 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
8255 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
8256 100)))
8257
8258(setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
8259@end lisp
8260
8261These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
8262preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
8263It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
8264
8265@vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
8266Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
8267@code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
8268articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
8269
8270@table @code
8271@item read
8272Remove articles when they are read.
8273
8274@item exit
8275Remove articles when exiting the group.
8276@end table
8277
8278The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
8279
8280@c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
8281@c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
8282@c from the next group.
8283
8284
8285@node Article Caching
8286@section Article Caching
8287@cindex article caching
8288@cindex caching
8289
8290If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
8291consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
8292locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
8293potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
8294your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
8295
8296Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
8297
8298@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8299@vindex gnus-cache-directory
8300@vindex gnus-use-cache
8301To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
8302all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
8303over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
8304cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
8305@code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
8306
8307When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
8308cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
8309expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
8310keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
8311as dormant, and don't worry.
8312
8313When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
8314
8315@vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
8316@vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
8317The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
8318@code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
8319variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
8320dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
8321put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
8322articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
8323symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
8324@code{unread} and @code{read}.
8325
8326@findex gnus-jog-cache
8327So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
8328picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
8329subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
8330store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
8331command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
8332really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
8333Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
8334to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
8335not then be downloaded by this command.
8336
8337@vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
8338@vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
8339It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
8340if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
8341sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
8342feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
8343
8344To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
8345regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
8346@code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
8347Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
8348variables, the group is not cached.
8349
8350@findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
8351@findex gnus-cache-generate-active
8352@vindex gnus-cache-active-file
8353The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
8354file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
8355of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
8356offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
8357gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
8358files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
8359file.
8360
8361@findex gnus-cache-move-cache
8362@code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
8363@code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
8364where, isn't that cool?
8365
8366@node Persistent Articles
8367@section Persistent Articles
8368@cindex persistent articles
8369
8370Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
8371In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
8372useful in my opinion.
8373
8374Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
8375that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
8376(using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
8377that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
8378the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
8379the expiry going on at the news server.
8380
8381This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
8382be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
8383you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
8384
8385@table @kbd
8386
8387@item *
8388@kindex * (Summary)
8389@findex gnus-cache-enter-article
8390Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
8391
8392@item M-*
8393@kindex M-* (Summary)
8394@findex gnus-cache-remove-article
8395Remove the current article from the persistent articles
8396(@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
8397article.
8398@end table
8399
8400Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
8401
8402To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
8403you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
8404interested in persistent articles:
8405
8406@lisp
8407(setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
8408@end lisp
8409
01c52d31
MB
8410@node Sticky Articles
8411@section Sticky Articles
8412@cindex sticky articles
8413
8414When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
8415according to the value of the variable
8416@code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
8417default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
8418has its own article buffer.
8419
8420This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
8421in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
8422latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
8423your 17 cousins to coordinate the next christmas party.
8424
8425That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
8426basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
8427select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
8428
8429@table @kbd
8430@item A S
8431@kindex A S (Summary)
8432@findex gnus-sticky-article
8433Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
8434name for this sticky article buffer.
8435@end table
8436
8437To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
8438
8439@table @kbd
8440@item q
8441@kindex q (Article)
8442@findex bury-buffer
8443Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
8444
8445@item k
8446@kindex k (Article)
8447@findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
8448Kills this sticky article buffer.
8449@end table
8450
8451To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
8452
8453@defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
8454Kill all sticky article buffers.
8455If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
8456@end defun
4009494e
GM
8457
8458@node Article Backlog
8459@section Article Backlog
8460@cindex backlog
8461@cindex article backlog
8462
8463If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
8464unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
8465by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
8466already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
8467you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
8468re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
8469that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
8470increase memory usage some.
8471
8472@vindex gnus-keep-backlog
8473If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
8474at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
8475variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
8476@emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
8477bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
8478that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
8479
8480The default value is 20.
8481
8482
8483@node Saving Articles
8484@section Saving Articles
8485@cindex saving articles
8486
8487Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
8488for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
8489processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
8490approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
8491(@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
8492
8493For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
8494save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
8495command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
8496
8497@vindex gnus-save-all-headers
8498If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
8499unwanted headers before saving the article.
8500
8501@vindex gnus-saved-headers
8502If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
8503@code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
8504deleted before saving.
8505
8506@table @kbd
8507
8508@item O o
8509@itemx o
8510@kindex O o (Summary)
8511@kindex o (Summary)
8512@findex gnus-summary-save-article
8513@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
8514Save the current article using the default article saver
8515(@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
8516
8517@item O m
8518@kindex O m (Summary)
8519@findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
8520Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
8521(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
8522
8523@item O r
8524@kindex O r (Summary)
8525@findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
8526Save the current article in Rmail format
8527(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
8528
8529@item O f
8530@kindex O f (Summary)
8531@findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
8532@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
8533Save the current article in plain file format
8534(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
8535
8536@item O F
8537@kindex O F (Summary)
8538@findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
8539Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
8540file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
8541
8542@item O b
8543@kindex O b (Summary)
8544@findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
8545Save the current article body in plain file format
8546(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
8547
8548@item O h
8549@kindex O h (Summary)
8550@findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
8551Save the current article in mh folder format
8552(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
8553
8554@item O v
8555@kindex O v (Summary)
8556@findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
8557Save the current article in a VM folder
8558(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
8559
8560@item O p
8561@itemx |
8562@kindex O p (Summary)
8563@kindex | (Summary)
8564@findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
89167438 8565@vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
4009494e
GM
8566Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
8567the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
8568If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
6ecfe5c2
MB
8569complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
8570special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
8571The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
8572to a string containing the default command and options (default
8573@code{nil}).
4009494e
GM
8574
8575@item O P
8576@kindex O P (Summary)
8577@findex gnus-summary-muttprint
8578@vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
8579Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
8580external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
8581Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
8582variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
8583(@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
8584
8585@end table
8586
8587@vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
8588All these commands use the process/prefix convention
8589(@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
8590functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
8591and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
8592the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
8593default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
8594loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
8595just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
8596have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
8597to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
8598save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
8599files.
8600
8601
8602@vindex gnus-default-article-saver
8603You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
8604Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
8605functions below, or you can create your own.
8606
8607@table @code
8608
8609@item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
8610@findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
8611@vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
8612@findex gnus-plain-save-name
8613This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
8614@code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8615article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
8616
8617@item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
8618@findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
8619@vindex gnus-mail-save-name
8620Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
8621@code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8622article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
8623
8624@item gnus-summary-save-in-file
8625@findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
8626@vindex gnus-file-save-name
8627@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8628Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
8629the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8630article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8631
8632@item gnus-summary-write-to-file
8633@findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
8634Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
8635overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
8636@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8637article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8638
8639@item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
8640@findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
8641Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
8642@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8643article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8644
8645@item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
8646@findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
8647Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
8648overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
8649@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8650article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8651
8652@item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
8653@findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
8654@findex gnus-folder-save-name
8655@findex gnus-Folder-save-name
8656@vindex gnus-folder-save-name
8657@cindex rcvstore
8658@cindex MH folders
8659Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
8660library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
8661to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
8662@code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
8663@code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
8664
8665@item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
8666@findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
8667Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
8668reader to use this setting.
89167438
MB
8669
8670@item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
8671@findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
d62672f3
MB
8672Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
8673arguments COMMAND and RAW. Valid values for COMMAND include:
8674
8675@itemize @bullet
8676@item a string@*
8677The executable command name and possibly arguments.
8678@item @code{nil}@*
8679You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
8680@item the symbol @code{default}@*
8681It will be replaced with the command which the variable
8682@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
8683last used for saving.
8684@end itemize
8685
8686Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
8687@code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
8688headers will be piped.
4009494e
GM
8689@end table
8690
8691The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
8692
8693@table @code
8694@item :decode
8695The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
8696meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
8697@code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
89167438
MB
8698@code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
8699@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
8700@code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
4009494e
GM
8701
8702@item :function
8703The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
8704overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
8705articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
8706@code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
8707meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
8708@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
8709
8710@item :headers
8711The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
8712specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
8713@code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
8714headers should be saved.
8715@end table
8716
8717@vindex gnus-article-save-directory
8718All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
8719in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
8720@env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
8721default.
8722
8723As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
8724suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
8725available functions that generate names:
8726
8727@table @code
8728
8729@item gnus-Numeric-save-name
8730@findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
8731File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8732
8733@item gnus-numeric-save-name
8734@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8735File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8736
8737@item gnus-Plain-save-name
8738@findex gnus-Plain-save-name
8739File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8740
8741@item gnus-plain-save-name
8742@findex gnus-plain-save-name
8743File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8744
8745@item gnus-sender-save-name
8746@findex gnus-sender-save-name
8747File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
8748@end table
8749
8750@vindex gnus-split-methods
8751You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8752the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8753save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8754related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8755like:
8756
8757@lisp
8758(("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8759 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8760 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8761 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8762@end lisp
8763
8764We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8765elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8766a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8767head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8768group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8769@code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8770the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8771result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8772called returns a string or a list of strings.
8773
8774You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8775saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8776then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8777name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8778
8779This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8780means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8781@code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8782name.
8783
8784Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8785lots of mail groups called things like
8786@samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8787these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8788following will do just that:
8789
8790@lisp
8791(defun my-save-name (group)
8792 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8793 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8794
8795(setq gnus-split-methods
8796 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8797 (my-save-name)))
8798@end lisp
8799
8800
8801@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8802Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8803@code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8804(@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8805the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8806all the files in the top level directory
8807(@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8808@file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8809on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8810Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8811
8812This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8813is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8814names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8815@code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8816contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8817for kill files.
8818
8819If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8820a spool, you could
8821
8822@lisp
8823(setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8824(setq gnus-default-article-saver
8825 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8826@end lisp
8827
8828Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8829ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8830the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8831around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8832
8833
8834@node Decoding Articles
8835@section Decoding Articles
8836@cindex decoding articles
8837
8838Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8839encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8840
8841@menu
8842* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8843* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8844* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8845* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8846* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8847* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8848@end menu
8849
8850@cindex series
8851@cindex article series
8852All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8853(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8854the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8855can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8856articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8857
8858Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8859simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8860last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8861
8862For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8863will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8864([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8865
8866Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8867series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8868commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8869
8870
8871@node Uuencoded Articles
8872@subsection Uuencoded Articles
8873@cindex uudecode
8874@cindex uuencoded articles
8875
8876@table @kbd
8877
8878@item X u
8879@kindex X u (Summary)
8880@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8881@c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8882Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8883
8884@item X U
8885@kindex X U (Summary)
8886@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8887Uudecodes and saves the current series
8888(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8889
8890@item X v u
8891@kindex X v u (Summary)
8892@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8893Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8894
8895@item X v U
8896@kindex X v U (Summary)
8897@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8898Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8899(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8900
8901@end table
8902
8903Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8904the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8905entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8906(@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8907(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8908
8909All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8910@sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8911the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8912articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8913@kbd{X u}.
8914
8915@vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8916Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8917@code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8918@samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8919automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8920you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8921off.
8922
8923
8924@node Shell Archives
8925@subsection Shell Archives
8926@cindex unshar
8927@cindex shell archives
8928@cindex shared articles
8929
8930Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8931sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8932some commands to deal with these:
8933
8934@table @kbd
8935
8936@item X s
8937@kindex X s (Summary)
8938@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8939Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8940
8941@item X S
8942@kindex X S (Summary)
8943@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8944Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8945
8946@item X v s
8947@kindex X v s (Summary)
8948@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8949Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8950
8951@item X v S
8952@kindex X v S (Summary)
8953@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8954Unshars, views and saves the current series
8955(@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8956@end table
8957
8958
8959@node PostScript Files
8960@subsection PostScript Files
8961@cindex PostScript
8962
8963@table @kbd
8964
8965@item X p
8966@kindex X p (Summary)
8967@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8968Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8969
8970@item X P
8971@kindex X P (Summary)
8972@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8973Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8974(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8975
8976@item X v p
8977@kindex X v p (Summary)
8978@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8979View the current PostScript series
8980(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8981
8982@item X v P
8983@kindex X v P (Summary)
8984@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8985View and save the current PostScript series
8986(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8987@end table
8988
8989
8990@node Other Files
8991@subsection Other Files
8992
8993@table @kbd
8994@item X o
8995@kindex X o (Summary)
8996@findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8997Save the current series
8998(@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8999
9000@item X b
9001@kindex X b (Summary)
9002@findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
9003Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
9004doesn't really work yet.
b890d447
MB
9005
9006@item X Y
9007@kindex X Y (Summary)
9008@findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
9009yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
4009494e
GM
9010@end table
9011
9012
9013@node Decoding Variables
9014@subsection Decoding Variables
9015
9016Adjective, not verb.
9017
9018@menu
9019* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
9020* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
9021* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
9022@end menu
9023
9024
9025@node Rule Variables
9026@subsubsection Rule Variables
9027@cindex rule variables
9028
9029Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
9030variables are of the form
9031
9032@lisp
9033 (list '(regexp1 command2)
9034 '(regexp2 command2)
9035 ...)
9036@end lisp
9037
9038@table @code
9039
9040@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
9041@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
9042@cindex sox
9043This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
9044for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
9045say something like:
9046@lisp
9047(setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
9048 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
9049@end lisp
9050
9051@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
9052@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
9053This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
9054user and default view rules.
9055
9056@item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
9057@vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
9058This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
9059archives.
9060@end table
9061
9062
9063@node Other Decode Variables
9064@subsubsection Other Decode Variables
9065
9066@table @code
9067@vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
9068
9069@item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
9070All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
9071successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
9072and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
9073anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
9074
9075@table @code
9076
9077@item gnus-uu-grab-view
9078@findex gnus-uu-grab-view
9079View the file.
9080
9081@item gnus-uu-grab-move
9082@findex gnus-uu-grab-move
9083Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
9084@end table
9085
9086@item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
9087@vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
9088Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
9089@code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
9090that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
9091time.
9092
9093@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
9094@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
9095Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
9096
9097@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
9098@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
9099Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
9100Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
9101@code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
9102kludgey.
9103
9104@item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
9105@vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
9106Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
9107
9108@item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
9109@vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
9110Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
9111looking for files to display.
9112
9113@item gnus-uu-view-and-save
9114@vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
9115Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
9116after viewing it.
9117
9118@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
9119@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
9120Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
9121rules.
9122
9123@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
9124@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
9125Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
9126unpacking commands.
9127
9128@item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
9129@vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
9130Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
9131from articles.
9132
9133@item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
9134@vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
9135Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
9136decoded articles as unread.
9137
9138@item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
9139@vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
9140Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
9141uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
9142
9143@item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
9144@vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
9145Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
9146
9147@item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
9148@vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
9149@cindex metamail
9150Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
9151commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
9152content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
9153@code{metamail} for viewing.
9154
9155@item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
9156@vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
9157Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
9158decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
9159@code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
9160embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
9161to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
9162simply dropped them.
9163
9164@end table
9165
9166
9167@node Uuencoding and Posting
9168@subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
9169
9170@table @code
9171
9172@item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
9173@vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
9174Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
9175before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
9176either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
9177for you when you post the article.
9178
9179@item gnus-uu-post-length
9180@vindex gnus-uu-post-length
9181Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
9182many articles it takes to post the entire file.
9183
9184@item gnus-uu-post-threaded
9185@vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
9186Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
9187thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
9188to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
9189seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
9190think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
9191
9192@item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
9193@vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
9194Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
9195article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
9196variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
9197at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
9198Default is @code{t}.
9199
9200@end table
9201
9202
9203@node Viewing Files
9204@subsection Viewing Files
9205@cindex viewing files
9206@cindex pseudo-articles
9207
9208After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
9209to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
9210viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
9211containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
9212uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
9213This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
9214of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
9215
9216Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
9217extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
9218``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
9219will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
9220
9221@vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
9222If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
9223until the viewing is done before proceeding.
9224
9225@vindex gnus-view-pseudos
9226If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
9227the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
9228immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
9229be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
9230
9231@vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
9232If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
9233pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
9234@code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
9235a list of parameters to that command.
9236
9237@vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
9238If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
9239pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
9240
9241So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
9242@emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
9243Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
9244
9245
9246@node Article Treatment
9247@section Article Treatment
9248
9249Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
9250object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
9251written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
9252writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
9253these articles easier.
9254
9255@menu
9256* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
9257* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
9258* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
9259* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
9260* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
9261* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
9262* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
9263* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
9264* Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
9265* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
9266* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
9267@end menu
9268
9269
9270@node Article Highlighting
9271@subsection Article Highlighting
9272@cindex highlighting
9273
9274Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
9275you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
9276
9277@table @kbd
9278
9279@item W H a
9280@kindex W H a (Summary)
9281@findex gnus-article-highlight
9282@findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
9283Do much highlighting of the current article
9284(@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
9285text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
9286
9287@item W H h
9288@kindex W H h (Summary)
9289@findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
9290@vindex gnus-header-face-alist
9291Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
9292highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
9293variable, which is a list where each element has the form
9294@code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
9295@var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
9296header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
9297(@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
9298the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
9299@var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
9300
9301@item W H c
9302@kindex W H c (Summary)
9303@findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
9304Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
9305
9306Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
9307
9308@table @code
9309@vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
9310
9311@item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
9312If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
931325000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
9314
9315@item gnus-cite-max-prefix
9316@vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
9317Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
9318
9319@item gnus-cite-face-list
9320@vindex gnus-cite-face-list
9321List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
9322When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
9323Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
9324This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
9325
9326@item gnus-supercite-regexp
9327@vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
9328Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
9329
9330@item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
9331@vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
9332Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
9333
9334@item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
9335@vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
9336Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
9337that it's a citation.
9338
9339@item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
9340@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
9341Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
9342
9343@item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
9344@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
9345Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
9346
9347@item gnus-cite-attribution-face
9348@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
9349Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
9350cited text belonging to the attribution.
9351
9352@item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
9353@vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
9354If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
9355beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
9356in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
9357is @code{t}.
9358
9359@end table
9360
9361
9362@item W H s
9363@kindex W H s (Summary)
9364@vindex gnus-signature-separator
9365@vindex gnus-signature-face
9366@findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
9367Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
9368Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
9369Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
9370highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
9371default.
9372
9373@end table
9374
9375@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
9376
9377
9378@node Article Fontisizing
9379@subsection Article Fontisizing
9380@cindex emphasis
9381@cindex article emphasis
9382
9383@findex gnus-article-emphasize
9384@kindex W e (Summary)
9385People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
9386like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
9387this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
9388(@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
9389
9390@vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
9391How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
9392@code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
9393element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
9394that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
9395emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
9396should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
9397groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
9398highlighting.
9399
9400@lisp
9401(setq gnus-emphasis-alist
9402 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
9403 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
9404@end lisp
9405
9406@cindex slash
9407@cindex asterisk
9408@cindex underline
9409@cindex /
9410@cindex *
9411
9412@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
9413@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
9414@vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
9415@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
9416@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
9417@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
9418@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
9419By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
9420@code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
9421@code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
9422@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
9423@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
9424@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
9425
9426If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
9427customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
9428to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
9429say something like:
9430
9431@lisp
9432(copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
9433@end lisp
9434
9435@vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
9436
9437If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
9438@code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
9439syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
9440parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
9441
9442@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
9443
9444
9445@node Article Hiding
9446@subsection Article Hiding
9447@cindex article hiding
9448
9449Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
9450too much cruft in most articles.
9451
9452@table @kbd
9453
9454@item W W a
9455@kindex W W a (Summary)
9456@findex gnus-article-hide
9457Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
9458(@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
9459headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
9460
9461@item W W h
9462@kindex W W h (Summary)
9463@findex gnus-article-hide-headers
9464Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
9465Headers}.
9466
9467@item W W b
9468@kindex W W b (Summary)
9469@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
9470Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
9471(@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
9472
9473@item W W s
9474@kindex W W s (Summary)
9475@findex gnus-article-hide-signature
9476Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
9477Signature}.
9478
9479@item W W l
9480@kindex W W l (Summary)
9481@findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
9482@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
9483Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
9484are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
9485@code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
9486@samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
9487may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
9488
9489@table @code
9490
9491@item gnus-list-identifiers
9492@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
9493A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
9494subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
9495
9496@end table
9497
9498@item W W P
9499@kindex W W P (Summary)
9500@findex gnus-article-hide-pem
9501Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
9502(@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
9503
9504@item W W B
9505@kindex W W B (Summary)
9506@findex gnus-article-strip-banner
9507@vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
9508@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9509@cindex banner
9510@cindex OneList
9511@cindex stripping advertisements
9512@cindex advertisements
9513Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
9514(@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
9515annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
9516groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
9517the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
9518group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
9519which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
9520removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
9521signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
9522corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
9523used.
9524
9525Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
9526the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
9527@code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
9528
9529@table @code
9530
9531@item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9532@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9533Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
9534@code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
9535matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
9536symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
9537a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
9538address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
9539sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
9540banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
9541sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
9542
9543@lisp
9544("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
9545 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
9546@end lisp
9547
9548@end table
9549
9550@item W W c
9551@kindex W W c (Summary)
9552@findex gnus-article-hide-citation
9553Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
9554customizing the hiding:
9555
9556@table @code
9557
9558@item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
9559@itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
9560@vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
9561@vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
9562Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
9563allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
9564by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
9565specs are valid:
9566
9567@table @samp
9568@item b
9569Starting point of the hidden text.
9570@item e
9571Ending point of the hidden text.
9572@item l
9573Number of characters in the hidden region.
9574@item n
9575Number of lines of hidden text.
9576@end table
9577
9578@item gnus-cited-lines-visible
9579@vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
9580The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
9581shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
9582and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
9583
9584@end table
9585
9586@item W W C-c
9587@kindex W W C-c (Summary)
9588@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
9589
9590Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
9591following two variables:
9592
9593@table @code
9594@item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
9595@vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
9596If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
959750), hide the cited text.
9598
9599@item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
9600@vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
9601The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
9602is hidden.
9603@end table
9604
9605@item W W C
9606@kindex W W C (Summary)
9607@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
9608Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
9609(@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
9610useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
9611have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
9612
9613@end table
9614
9615All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
9616prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
9617hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
9618
9619Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
9620citation customization.
9621
9622@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
9623automatically.
9624
9625
9626@node Article Washing
9627@subsection Article Washing
9628@cindex washing
9629@cindex article washing
9630
9631We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
9632@kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
9633
9634@dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
9635something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
9636Cleaner, perhaps.
9637
9638@xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
9639articles by default.
9640
9641@table @kbd
9642
9643@item C-u g
9644This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
9645you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
9646the server.
9647
9648@item g
9649Force redisplaying of the current article
9650(@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
9651If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
9652interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
9653(@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
9654
9655@item W l
9656@kindex W l (Summary)
9657@findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
9658Remove page breaks from the current article
9659(@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
9660delimiters.
9661
9662@item W r
9663@kindex W r (Summary)
9664@findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
9665@c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
9666Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
9667(@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
9668Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
9669(Typically offensive jokes and such.)
9670
9671It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
9672positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
9673#15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
9674is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
9675
9676@item W m
9677@kindex W m (Summary)
9678@findex gnus-summary-morse-message
9679Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
9680
01c52d31
MB
9681@item W i
9682@kindex W i (Summary)
9683@findex gnus-summary-idna-message
9684Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
9685encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
9686unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
9687string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
9688(@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
9689to work.
9690
4009494e
GM
9691@item W t
9692@item t
9693@kindex W t (Summary)
9694@kindex t (Summary)
9695@findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
9696Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
9697(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
9698
9699@item W v
9700@kindex W v (Summary)
9701@findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
9702Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
9703(@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
9704
9705@item W o
9706@kindex W o (Summary)
9707@findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
9708Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
9709
9710@item W d
9711@kindex W d (Summary)
9712@findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
9713@vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
9714@cindex Smartquotes
9715@cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
9716@cindex Latin 1
9717Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
9718@code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
9719(@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
9720whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
9721interactively.
9722
9723Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
9724an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
9725like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
9726apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
9727
9728@item W Y f
9729@kindex W Y f (Summary)
9730@findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9731@cindex Outlook Express
9732Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9733unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9734(@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
9735
9736@item W Y u
9737@kindex W Y u (Summary)
9738@findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9739@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9740@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9741Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9742what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9743@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9744@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9745maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9746(@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9747
9748@item W Y a
9749@kindex W Y a (Summary)
9750@findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9751Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9752(@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9753
9754@item W Y c
9755@kindex W Y c (Summary)
9756@findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9757Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9758(@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9759
9760@item W w
9761@kindex W w (Summary)
9762@findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9763Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9764
9765You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9766when filling.
9767
9768@item W Q
9769@kindex W Q (Summary)
9770@findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9771Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9772
9773@item W C
9774@kindex W C (Summary)
9775@findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9776Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9777(@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9778
9779@item W c
9780@kindex W c (Summary)
9781@findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9782Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9783(this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9784CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9785(@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9786
9787@item W q
9788@kindex W q (Summary)
9789@findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9790Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9791Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9792sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
01c52d31
MB
9793makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9794which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9795done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
4009494e
GM
9796@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9797has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9798
9799@item W 6
9800@kindex W 6 (Summary)
9801@findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9802Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9803one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9804non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9805usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9806@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9807has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9808
9809@item W Z
9810@kindex W Z (Summary)
9811@findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9812Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9813common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9814makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9815
01c52d31
MB
9816@item W A
9817@kindex W A (Summary)
9818@findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9819@cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9820Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9821extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9822sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9823
4009494e
GM
9824@item W u
9825@kindex W u (Summary)
9826@findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9827Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9828outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9829split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9830the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9831
9832@item W h
9833@kindex W h (Summary)
9834@findex gnus-article-wash-html
9835Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9836usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9837@code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9838
9839If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9840the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9841(@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9842
9843@vindex gnus-article-wash-function
9844The default is to use the function specified by
9845@code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9846Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9847@acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
9848@code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
9849can use include:
9850
9851@table @code
9852@item w3
9853Use Emacs/W3.
9854
9855@item w3m
9856Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9857
9858@item w3m-standalone
9859Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9860
9861@item links
9862Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9863
9864@item lynx
9865Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9866
9867@item html2text
9868Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9869
9870@end table
9871
9872@item W b
9873@kindex W b (Summary)
9874@findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9875Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9876@xref{Article Buttons}.
9877
9878@item W B
9879@kindex W B (Summary)
9880@findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9881Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9882(@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9883
9884@item W p
9885@kindex W p (Summary)
9886@findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9887Verify a signed control message
9888(@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9889@code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9890hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9891the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9892message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9893available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9894
9895@item W s
9896@kindex W s (Summary)
9897@findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9898Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9899@acronym{S/MIME}) message
9900(@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9901
9902@item W a
9903@kindex W a (Summary)
9904@findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9905Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9906article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9907
9908@item W E l
9909@kindex W E l (Summary)
9910@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9911Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9912(@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9913
9914@item W E m
9915@kindex W E m (Summary)
9916@findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9917Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9918lines with a single empty line.
9919(@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9920
9921@item W E t
9922@kindex W E t (Summary)
9923@findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9924Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9925(@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9926
9927@item W E a
9928@kindex W E a (Summary)
9929@findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9930Do all the three commands above
9931(@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9932
9933@item W E A
9934@kindex W E A (Summary)
9935@findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9936Remove all blank lines
9937(@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9938
9939@item W E s
9940@kindex W E s (Summary)
9941@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9942Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9943body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9944
9945@item W E e
9946@kindex W E e (Summary)
9947@findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9948Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9949body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9950
9951@end table
9952
9953@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9954
9955
9956@node Article Header
9957@subsection Article Header
9958
9959These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9960
9961@table @kbd
9962
9963@item W G u
9964@kindex W G u (Summary)
9965@findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9966Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9967
9968@item W G n
9969@kindex W G n (Summary)
9970@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9971Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9972(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9973
9974@item W G f
9975@kindex W G f (Summary)
9976@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9977Fold all the message headers
9978(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9979
9980@item W E w
9981@kindex W E w (Summary)
9982@findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9983Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9984(@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9985
9986@end table
9987
9988
9989@node Article Buttons
9990@subsection Article Buttons
9991@cindex buttons
9992
9993People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9994be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9995with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9996button on these references.
9997
9998@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9999Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
10000Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
10001Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
10002one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
10003
10004@table @code
10005
10006@item gnus-button-alist
10007@vindex gnus-button-alist
10008This is an alist where each entry has this form:
10009
10010@lisp
10011(@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
10012@end lisp
10013
10014@table @var
10015
10016@item regexp
10017All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
10018considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
10019embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
10020variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
10021@code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
10022
10023@item button-par
10024Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
10025is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
10026highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
10027
10028@item use-p
10029This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
10030this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
10031avoid false matches. Often variables named
10032@code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
10033Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
10034
10035@c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
10036
10037@item function
10038This function will be called when you click on this button.
10039
10040@item data-par
10041As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
10042says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
10043
10044@end table
10045
10046So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
10047
10048@lisp
10049("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
10050@end lisp
10051
10052@item gnus-header-button-alist
10053@vindex gnus-header-button-alist
10054This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
10055article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
10056used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
10057
10058@lisp
10059(@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
10060@end lisp
10061
10062@var{header} is a regular expression.
10063@end table
10064
10065@subsubsection Related variables and functions
10066
10067@table @code
10068@item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
10069@xref{Article Button Levels}.
10070
10071@c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
10072
10073@item gnus-button-url-regexp
10074@vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
10075A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
10076default values of the variables above.
10077
10078@c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
10079
10080@item gnus-button-man-handler
10081@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
10082The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
10083argument with a string naming the man page.
10084
10085@c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
10086
10087@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
10088@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
10089Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
10090
10091@item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
10092@vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
10093This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
10094@samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
10095message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
10096@code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
10097a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
10098@code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
10099function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
10100function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
10101@code{ask}. The default value is the function
10102@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
10103
10104@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
10105@findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
10106Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
10107address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
10108it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
10109string is invalid.
10110
10111@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
10112@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
10113An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
10114@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
10115
10116@c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
10117
10118@item gnus-button-ctan-handler
10119@findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
10120The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
10121argument, the string naming the URL.
10122
10123@item gnus-ctan-url
10124@vindex gnus-ctan-url
10125Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
10126by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
10127
10128@c Misc stuff
10129
10130@item gnus-article-button-face
10131@vindex gnus-article-button-face
10132Face used on buttons.
10133
10134@item gnus-article-mouse-face
10135@vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
10136Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
10137
10138@end table
10139
10140@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
10141
10142
10143@node Article Button Levels
10144@subsection Article button levels
10145@cindex button levels
10146The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
10147the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
10148buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
10149already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
10150more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
10151you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
10152specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
10153variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
10154
10155@lisp
10156;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
10157(setq gnus-parameters
10158 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
10159 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
10160 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
10161@end lisp
10162
10163@table @code
10164
10165@item gnus-button-browse-level
10166@vindex gnus-button-browse-level
10167Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
10168news URLs. Related variables and functions include
10169@code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
10170@code{browse-url-browser-function}.
10171
10172@item gnus-button-emacs-level
10173@vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
10174Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
10175@code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
10176@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
10177@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
10178@code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
10179@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
10180@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
10181@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
10182@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
10183@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
10184@code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
10185
10186@item gnus-button-man-level
10187@vindex gnus-button-man-level
10188Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
10189See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
10190
10191@item gnus-button-message-level
10192@vindex gnus-button-message-level
10193Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
10194Related variables and functions include
10195@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
10196@code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
10197@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
10198@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
10199
10200@item gnus-button-tex-level
10201@vindex gnus-button-tex-level
10202Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
10203URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
10204@code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
10205@code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
10206@code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
10207
10208@end table
10209
10210
10211@node Article Date
10212@subsection Article Date
10213
10214The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
10215heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
10216when the article was sent.
10217
10218@table @kbd
10219
10220@item W T u
10221@kindex W T u (Summary)
10222@findex gnus-article-date-ut
10223Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
10224(@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
10225
10226@item W T i
10227@kindex W T i (Summary)
10228@findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
10229@cindex ISO 8601
10230Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
10231(@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
10232
10233@item W T l
10234@kindex W T l (Summary)
10235@findex gnus-article-date-local
10236Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
10237
10238@item W T p
10239@kindex W T p (Summary)
10240@findex gnus-article-date-english
10241Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
10242(@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
10243
10244@item W T s
10245@kindex W T s (Summary)
10246@vindex gnus-article-time-format
10247@findex gnus-article-date-user
10248@findex format-time-string
10249Display the date using a user-defined format
10250(@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
10251@code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
10252to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
10253for a list of possible format specs.
10254
10255@item W T e
10256@kindex W T e (Summary)
10257@findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
10258@findex gnus-start-date-timer
10259@findex gnus-stop-date-timer
10260Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
10261(@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
10262
10263@example
10264X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
10265@end example
10266
10267@vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
10268The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
10269whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
10270replace it.
10271
10272An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
10273into wonderful absurdities.
10274
10275If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
10276
10277@lisp
10278(gnus-start-date-timer)
10279@end lisp
10280
10281in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
10282you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
10283command.
10284
10285@item W T o
10286@kindex W T o (Summary)
10287@findex gnus-article-date-original
10288Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
10289be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
10290worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
10291that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
10292@emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
10293
10294@end table
10295
10296@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
10297preferred format automatically.
10298
10299
10300@node Article Display
10301@subsection Article Display
10302@cindex picons
10303@cindex x-face
10304@cindex smileys
10305
10306These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
10307buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
10308
10309@code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
10310message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
10311
10312@code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
10313headers (@pxref{Face}).
10314
10315Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
10316their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
10317
10318Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
10319try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
10320
10321All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
10322they'll be removed.
10323
10324@table @kbd
10325@item W D x
10326@kindex W D x (Summary)
10327@findex gnus-article-display-x-face
10328Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
10329(@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
10330
10331@item W D d
10332@kindex W D d (Summary)
10333@findex gnus-article-display-face
10334Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
10335(@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
10336
10337@item W D s
10338@kindex W D s (Summary)
10339@findex gnus-treat-smiley
10340Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
10341
10342@item W D f
10343@kindex W D f (Summary)
10344@findex gnus-treat-from-picon
10345Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
10346
10347@item W D m
10348@kindex W D m (Summary)
10349@findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
10350Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
10351(@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
10352
10353@item W D n
10354@kindex W D n (Summary)
10355@findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
10356Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
10357@code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
10358
10359@item W D D
10360@kindex W D D (Summary)
10361@findex gnus-article-remove-images
10362Remove all images from the article buffer
10363(@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
10364
10365@end table
10366
10367
10368
10369@node Article Signature
10370@subsection Article Signature
10371@cindex signatures
10372@cindex article signature
10373
10374@vindex gnus-signature-separator
10375Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
10376body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
10377that says what is to be considered a signature is
10378@code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
10379@samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
10380non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
10381of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
10382from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
10383
10384@lisp
10385(setq gnus-signature-separator
10386 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
10387 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
10388 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
10389 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
10390 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
10391 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
10392 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
10393@end lisp
10394
10395The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
10396positives.
10397
10398@vindex gnus-signature-limit
10399@code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
10400signature when displaying articles.
10401
10402@enumerate
10403@item
10404If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
10405that integer.
10406@item
10407If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
10408than that number.
10409@item
10410If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
10411and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
10412@item
10413If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
10414in question is not a signature.
10415@end enumerate
10416
10417This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
10418listed above. Here's an example:
10419
10420@lisp
10421(setq gnus-signature-limit
10422 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
10423@end lisp
10424
10425This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
10426separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
10427the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
10428signature after all.
10429
10430
10431@node Article Miscellanea
10432@subsection Article Miscellanea
10433
10434@table @kbd
10435@item A t
10436@kindex A t (Summary)
10437@findex gnus-article-babel
10438Translate the article from one language to another
10439(@code{gnus-article-babel}).
10440
10441@end table
10442
10443
10444@node MIME Commands
10445@section MIME Commands
10446@cindex MIME decoding
10447@cindex attachments
10448@cindex viewing attachments
10449
10450The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
01c52d31 10451instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
4009494e
GM
10452
10453@table @kbd
10454@item b
10455@itemx K v
10456@kindex b (Summary)
10457@kindex K v (Summary)
10458View the @acronym{MIME} part.
10459
10460@item K o
10461@kindex K o (Summary)
10462Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
10463
01c52d31
MB
10464@item K O
10465@kindex K O (Summary)
10466Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
10467from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
10468via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10469
10470@item K r
10471@kindex K r (Summary)
10472Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
10473
10474@item K d
10475@kindex K d (Summary)
10476Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
10477removed part.
10478
4009494e
GM
10479@item K c
10480@kindex K c (Summary)
10481Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
10482
10483@item K e
10484@kindex K e (Summary)
10485View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
10486
10487@item K i
10488@kindex K i (Summary)
10489View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
10490
10491@item K |
10492@kindex K | (Summary)
10493Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
10494@end table
10495
10496The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
10497the same manner:
10498
10499@table @kbd
9b3ebcb6
MB
10500@item K H
10501@kindex K H (Summary)
10502@findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
10503View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
10504The message header is added to the beginning of every html part unless
10505the prefix argument is given.
10506
10507Warning: Spammers use links to images in HTML articles to verify whether
10508you have read the message. As this command passes the @acronym{HTML}
10509content to the browser without eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should
10510only use it for mails from trusted senders.
10511
10512If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
10513@code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
10514
4009494e
GM
10515@item K b
10516@kindex K b (Summary)
10517Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
10518mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
10519parts.
10520
10521@item K m
10522@kindex K m (Summary)
10523@findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
10524Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
10525This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
10526be viewed in a more pleasant manner
10527(@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
10528
10529@item X m
10530@kindex X m (Summary)
10531@findex gnus-summary-save-parts
10532Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
10533(@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
10534convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10535
10536@item M-t
10537@kindex M-t (Summary)
10538@findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
10539Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
10540(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
10541
10542@item W M w
10543@kindex W M w (Summary)
10544@findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
10545Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
10546(@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
10547
10548@item W M c
10549@kindex W M c (Summary)
10550@findex gnus-article-decode-charset
10551Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
10552(@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
10553
10554This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
10555charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
10556prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
10557groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
10558include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
10559parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
10560
10561@item W M v
10562@kindex W M v (Summary)
10563@findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
10564View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
10565(@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
10566
10567@end table
10568
10569Relevant variables:
10570
10571@table @code
10572@item gnus-ignored-mime-types
10573@vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
10574This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10575this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
10576@code{nil}.
10577
10578To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
10579
10580@lisp
10581(setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
10582 '("text/x-vcard"))
10583@end lisp
10584
10585@item gnus-article-loose-mime
10586@vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
10587If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
10588before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
10589when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
b890d447 10590default is @code{t}.
4009494e
GM
10591
10592@item gnus-article-emulate-mime
10593@vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
10594@cindex uuencode
10595@cindex yEnc
10596There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
10597is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
10598this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
10599see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
10600Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
10601single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
10602for encoding in Gnus.
10603
10604@item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
10605@vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
10606This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10607this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
10608displayed or this variable is overridden by
10609@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
10610@code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
10611@code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
10612
10613@item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
10614@vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
10615This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10616this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
10617displayed. This variable overrides
10618@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
10619This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
10620is @code{nil}.
10621
10622To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
10623variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
10624@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
10625
10626You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
10627display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
10628those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
10629(@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
10630Emacs MIME Manual}).
10631
10632@item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
10633@vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
10634If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
10635default value is @code{nil}.
10636
10637@item gnus-article-mime-part-function
10638@vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
10639For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
10640handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
10641users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
10642the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
10643save all jpegs into some directory).
10644
10645Here's an example function the does the latter:
10646
10647@lisp
10648(defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
10649 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
10650 (with-temp-buffer
10651 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
10652 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
10653 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
10654(setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
10655 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
10656@end lisp
10657
10658@vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
10659@item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
10660Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
10661
10662@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
10663@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
10664Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
10665
10666@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
10667@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
10668Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
10669
9b3ebcb6 10670If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
4009494e
GM
10671@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
10672"multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
10673@code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
10674emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
10675
10676@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
10677@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
10678Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
10679overrides @code{nil} values of
10680@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
10681@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
10682
10683@vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10684@item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10685List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
10686Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
10687
10688Ready-made functions include@*
10689@code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
10690@code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
10691@code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
10692@code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
10693the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
10694whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
10695is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
10696@findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
10697@findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10698@findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10699@findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10700@vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10701
10702The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
10703@code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
10704
10705Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
10706except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
10707such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
10708
10709@lisp
10710(setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10711 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10712 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10713 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
10714@end lisp
10715
10716@noindent
10717to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
10718
10719@end table
10720
10721
10722@node Charsets
10723@section Charsets
10724@cindex charsets
10725
10726People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10727charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10728newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10729just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10730help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10731what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10732hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10733
10734@vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10735This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10736variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10737group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10738
10739@vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10740In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10741aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10742even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10743@code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10744charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10745set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10746Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10747which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10748
10749@vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10750When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10751determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10752encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10753quoted-printable header encoding.
10754
10755This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10756for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10757header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10758
10759@table @var
10760@item test
10761is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10762variable to query,
10763@item header
10764is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10765means encode all charsets),
10766@item body-list
10767is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10768encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10769encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10770@end table
10771
10772@cindex Russian
10773@cindex koi8-r
10774@cindex koi8-u
10775@cindex iso-8859-5
10776@cindex coding system aliases
10777@cindex preferred charset
10778
10779@xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10780The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10781MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10782
10783Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10784
10785If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10786charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10787
10788@lisp
10789(put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10790 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10791@end lisp
10792
10793This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10794the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10795
10796If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10797
10798@lisp
10799(define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10800@end lisp
10801
10802This will almost do the right thing.
10803
10804And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10805something like
10806
10807@lisp
10808(codepage-setup 1251)
10809(define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10810@end lisp
10811
10812
10813@node Article Commands
10814@section Article Commands
10815
10816@table @kbd
10817
10818@item A P
10819@cindex PostScript
10820@cindex printing
10821@kindex A P (Summary)
10822@vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10823@findex gnus-summary-print-article
10824Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10825(@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10826be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10827article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10828
10829@end table
10830
10831
10832@node Summary Sorting
10833@section Summary Sorting
10834@cindex summary sorting
10835
10836You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10837can't really see why you'd want that.
10838
10839@table @kbd
10840
10841@item C-c C-s C-n
10842@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10843@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10844Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10845
6ecfe5c2
MB
10846@item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10847@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10848@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10849Sort by most recent article number
10850(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10851
4009494e
GM
10852@item C-c C-s C-a
10853@kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10854@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10855Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10856
01c52d31
MB
10857@item C-c C-s C-t
10858@kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10859@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10860Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10861
4009494e
GM
10862@item C-c C-s C-s
10863@kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10864@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10865Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10866
10867@item C-c C-s C-d
10868@kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10869@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10870Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10871
6ecfe5c2
MB
10872@item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10873@kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10874@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10875Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10876
4009494e
GM
10877@item C-c C-s C-l
10878@kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10879@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10880Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10881
10882@item C-c C-s C-c
10883@kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10884@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10885Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10886
10887@item C-c C-s C-i
10888@kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10889@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10890Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10891
10892@item C-c C-s C-r
10893@kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10894@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10895Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10896
10897@item C-c C-s C-o
10898@kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10899@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10900Sort using the default sorting method
10901(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10902@end table
10903
10904These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10905use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10906line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10907root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10908toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10909Commands}).
10910
6ecfe5c2
MB
10911If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10912
4009494e
GM
10913
10914@node Finding the Parent
10915@section Finding the Parent
10916@cindex parent articles
10917@cindex referring articles
10918
10919@table @kbd
10920@item ^
10921@kindex ^ (Summary)
10922@findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10923If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10924displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10925if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10926and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10927can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10928(@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10929you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10930summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10931
10932If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10933the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10934ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10935grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10936@kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10937article.
10938
10939@item A R (Summary)
10940@findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10941@kindex A R (Summary)
10942Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10943article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10944
10945@item A T (Summary)
10946@findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10947@kindex A T (Summary)
10948Display the full thread where the current article appears
10949(@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10950headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10951you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10952to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10953visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10954faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10955
10956@vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10957The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
10958articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10959fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10960the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10961by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10962
10963@item M-^ (Summary)
10964@findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10965@kindex M-^ (Summary)
10966@cindex Message-ID
10967@cindex fetching by Message-ID
10968You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10969belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10970for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10971thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10972You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10973
10974Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10975been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10976@code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10977@end table
10978
10979@vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10980If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10981support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10982you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10983would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10984updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10985necessary.
10986
10987It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10988@code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10989is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10990match.
10991
10992Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10993then ask Google if that fails:
10994
10995@lisp
10996(setq gnus-refer-article-method
10997 '(current
10998 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10999@end lisp
11000
11001Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
11002do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
11003@code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
11004articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
11005only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
11006group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
11007not support this at all.
11008
11009
11010@node Alternative Approaches
11011@section Alternative Approaches
11012
11013Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
11014Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
11015
11016@menu
11017* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
11018* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
11019@end menu
11020
11021
11022@node Pick and Read
11023@subsection Pick and Read
11024@cindex pick and read
11025
11026Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
11027a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
11028buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
11029articles with just an article buffer displayed.
11030
11031@findex gnus-pick-mode
11032@kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
11033Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
11034this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
11035mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
11036it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
11037
11038Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
11039
11040@table @kbd
11041@item .
11042@kindex . (Pick)
11043@findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
11044Pick the article or thread on the current line
11045(@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
11046@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
11047entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
11048it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
11049thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
11050at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
11051
11052@item SPACE
11053@kindex SPACE (Pick)
11054@findex gnus-pick-next-page
11055Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
11056at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
11057
11058@item u
11059@kindex u (Pick)
11060@findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
11061Unpick the thread or article
11062(@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
11063@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
11064thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
11065just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
11066the thread or article at that line.
11067
11068@item RET
11069@kindex RET (Pick)
11070@findex gnus-pick-start-reading
11071@vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
11072Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
11073given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
11074@code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
11075will still be visible when you are reading.
11076
11077@end table
11078
11079All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
11080pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
11081which is mapped to the same function
11082@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
11083
11084If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
11085
11086@lisp
11087(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
11088@end lisp
11089
11090@vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
11091@code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
11092
11093@vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
11094If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
11095all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
11096
11097@vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
11098The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
11099standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
11100displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
11101@code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
11102Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
11103@code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
11104
11105
11106@node Binary Groups
11107@subsection Binary Groups
11108@cindex binary groups
11109
11110@findex gnus-binary-mode
11111@kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
11112If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
11113@kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
11114is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
11115selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
11116instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
11117
11118@kindex g (Binary)
11119@findex gnus-binary-show-article
11120The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
11121command, when you have turned on this mode
11122(@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
11123
11124@vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
11125@code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
11126
11127
11128@node Tree Display
11129@section Tree Display
11130@cindex trees
11131
11132@vindex gnus-use-trees
11133If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
11134@code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
11135additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
11136in the tree buffer.
11137
11138There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
11139
11140@table @code
11141@item gnus-tree-mode-hook
11142@vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
11143A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
11144
11145@item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
11146@vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
11147A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
11148Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
11149of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
11150
11151@item gnus-selected-tree-face
11152@vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
11153Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
11154default is @code{modeline}.
11155
11156@item gnus-tree-line-format
11157@vindex gnus-tree-line-format
11158A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
11159though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
11160is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
11161the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
11162length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
11163
11164Valid specs are:
11165
11166@table @samp
11167@item n
11168The name of the poster.
11169@item f
11170The @code{From} header.
11171@item N
11172The number of the article.
11173@item [
11174The opening bracket.
11175@item ]
11176The closing bracket.
11177@item s
11178The subject.
11179@end table
11180
11181@xref{Formatting Variables}.
11182
11183Variables related to the display are:
11184
11185@table @code
11186@item gnus-tree-brackets
11187@vindex gnus-tree-brackets
11188This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
11189``sparse'' articles. The format is
11190@example
11191((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
11192 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
11193 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
11194@end example
11195and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
11196
11197@item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
11198@vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
11199This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
11200nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
11201
11202@end table
11203
11204@item gnus-tree-minimize-window
11205@vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
11206If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
11207buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
11208windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
11209higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
11210have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
11211buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
11212other windows displayed next to it.
11213
11214You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
11215at all times:
11216
11217@lisp
11218(add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
11219 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
11220@end lisp
11221
11222@item gnus-generate-tree-function
11223@vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
11224@findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
11225@findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
11226The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
11227functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
11228@code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
11229
11230@end table
11231
11232Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
11233
11234@example
11235@{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
11236 | \[Jan]
11237 | \[odd]-[Eri]
11238 | \(***)-[Eri]
11239 | \[odd]-[Paa]
11240 \[Bjo]
11241 \[Gun]
11242 \[Gun]-[Jor]
11243@end example
11244
11245Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
11246
11247@example
11248@group
11249@{***@}
11250 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
11251(***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
11252 |--\-----\-----\ |
11253[odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
11254 | | |--\
11255[Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
11256 |
11257 [Paa]
11258@end group
11259@end example
11260
11261If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
11262side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
11263following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11264
11265@lisp
11266(setq gnus-use-trees t
11267 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
11268 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
11269(gnus-add-configuration
11270 '(article
11271 (vertical 1.0
11272 (horizontal 0.25
11273 (summary 0.75 point)
11274 (tree 1.0))
11275 (article 1.0))))
11276@end lisp
11277
11278@xref{Window Layout}.
11279
11280
11281@node Mail Group Commands
11282@section Mail Group Commands
11283@cindex mail group commands
11284
11285Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
11286invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
11287
11288All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
11289process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
11290
11291@table @kbd
11292
11293@item B e
11294@kindex B e (Summary)
11295@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
11296@cindex expiring mail
11297Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
11298process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
11299expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
11300(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
11301
11302@item B C-M-e
11303@kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
11304@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
11305@cindex expiring mail
11306Delete all the expirable articles in the group
11307(@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
11308articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
11309disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
11310
11311@item B DEL
11312@kindex B DEL (Summary)
11313@findex gnus-summary-delete-article
11314@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
11315Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
11316disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
11317(@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
11318
11319@item B m
11320@kindex B m (Summary)
11321@cindex move mail
11322@findex gnus-summary-move-article
11323@vindex gnus-preserve-marks
11324Move the article from one mail group to another
11325(@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
11326@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
11327
11328@item B c
11329@kindex B c (Summary)
11330@cindex copy mail
11331@findex gnus-summary-copy-article
11332@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
11333Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
11334(@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
11335@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
11336
11337@item B B
11338@kindex B B (Summary)
11339@cindex crosspost mail
11340@findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
11341Crosspost the current article to some other group
11342(@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
11343the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
11344be properly updated.
11345
11346@item B i
11347@kindex B i (Summary)
11348@findex gnus-summary-import-article
11349Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
11350(@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
11351name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
11352
11353@item B I
11354@kindex B I (Summary)
11355@findex gnus-summary-create-article
11356Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
11357(@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
11358@code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
11359
11360@item B r
11361@kindex B r (Summary)
11362@findex gnus-summary-respool-article
11363@vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
11364Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
11365@code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
11366select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
11367which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
11368Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
11369(which is the default).
11370
11371@item B w
11372@itemx e
11373@kindex B w (Summary)
11374@kindex e (Summary)
11375@findex gnus-summary-edit-article
11376@kindex C-c C-c (Article)
11377@findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
11378Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
11379editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
11380(@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
11381@kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
11382
11383@item B q
11384@kindex B q (Summary)
11385@findex gnus-summary-respool-query
11386If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
11387the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
11388will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
11389
11390@item B t
11391@kindex B t (Summary)
11392@findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
11393Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
11394when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
11395
11396@item B p
11397@kindex B p (Summary)
11398@findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
11399Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
11400follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
11401@code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
11402(@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
11403article from your news server (or rather, from
11404@code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
11405report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
11406it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
11407propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
11408just not have arrived yet.
11409
11410@item K E
11411@kindex K E (Summary)
11412@findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
11413@vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
11414Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
11415The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
11416variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
11417
11418@end table
11419
11420@vindex gnus-move-split-methods
11421@cindex moving articles
11422If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
11423suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
11424variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
11425(@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
11426suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
11427@code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
11428@code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
11429
11430@lisp
11431(setq gnus-move-split-methods
11432 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
11433 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
11434 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
11435@end lisp
11436
11437
11438@node Various Summary Stuff
11439@section Various Summary Stuff
11440
11441@menu
11442* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
11443* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
11444* Summary Generation Commands::
11445* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
11446@end menu
11447
11448@table @code
11449@vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
11450@item gnus-summary-display-while-building
11451If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
11452built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
11453If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
11454lines. The default is @code{nil}.
11455
11456@vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
11457@item gnus-summary-display-arrow
11458If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
11459current article.
11460
11461@vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
11462@item gnus-summary-mode-hook
11463This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
11464
11465@vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
11466@item gnus-summary-generate-hook
11467This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
11468generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
11469the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
11470is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
11471have been set.
11472
11473@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
11474@item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
11475It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
11476it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
11477some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
11478
11479@vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
11480@item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
11481A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
11482generated.
11483
11484@vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
11485@item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
11486When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
11487it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
11488same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
11489sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
11490If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
11491@code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
11492any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
11493article---it'll be as if it never existed.
11494
11495@vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
11496@item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
11497This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
11498of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
11499list of articles to be selected.
11500
11501For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
11502the list in one particular group:
11503
11504@lisp
11505(defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
11506 (if (string= group "some.group")
11507 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
11508 articles))
11509@end lisp
11510
11511@vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
11512@item gnus-newsgroup-variables
11513A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
11514variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
11515values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
11516buffer is active.
11517
11518Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
11519@code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
11520assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
11521that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
11522variable will be used instead.
11523
11524These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
11525while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
11526buffers. For example:
11527
11528@lisp
11529(setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
11530 '(message-use-followup-to
11531 (gnus-visible-headers .
11532 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
11533@end lisp
11534
11535Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
3a23a519
MB
11536
11537@vindex gnus-propagate-marks
11538@item gnus-propagate-marks
11539If non-@code{nil}, propagate marks to the backends for possible
11540storing. @xref{NNTP marks}, and friends, for a more fine-grained
11541sieve.
11542
4009494e
GM
11543@end table
11544
11545
11546@node Summary Group Information
11547@subsection Summary Group Information
11548
11549@table @kbd
11550
11551@item H f
11552@kindex H f (Summary)
11553@findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
11554@vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
11555Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
11556for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
11557to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
11558is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
11559a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
11560will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
11561or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
11562
11563@item H d
11564@kindex H d (Summary)
11565@findex gnus-summary-describe-group
11566Give a brief description of the current group
11567(@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
11568rereading the description from the server.
11569
11570@item H h
11571@kindex H h (Summary)
11572@findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
11573Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
11574keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
11575
11576@item H i
11577@kindex H i (Summary)
11578@findex gnus-info-find-node
11579Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
11580@end table
11581
11582
11583@node Searching for Articles
11584@subsection Searching for Articles
11585
11586@table @kbd
11587
11588@item M-s
11589@kindex M-s (Summary)
11590@findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
11591Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
11592(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
11593
11594@item M-r
11595@kindex M-r (Summary)
11596@findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
11597Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
11598(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
11599
01c52d31
MB
11600@item M-S
11601@kindex M-S (Summary)
11602@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
11603Repeat the previous search forwards
11604(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
11605
11606@item M-R
11607@kindex M-R (Summary)
11608@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
11609Repeat the previous search backwards
11610(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
11611
4009494e
GM
11612@item &
11613@kindex & (Summary)
11614@findex gnus-summary-execute-command
11615This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
11616on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
11617(@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
11618string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
11619search backward instead.
11620
11621For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
11622all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
11623
11624@item M-&
11625@kindex M-& (Summary)
11626@findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
11627Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
11628the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
11629@end table
11630
11631@node Summary Generation Commands
11632@subsection Summary Generation Commands
11633
11634@table @kbd
11635
11636@item Y g
11637@kindex Y g (Summary)
11638@findex gnus-summary-prepare
11639Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
11640
11641@item Y c
11642@kindex Y c (Summary)
11643@findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
11644Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11645(@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
11646
11647@item Y d
11648@kindex Y d (Summary)
11649@findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
11650Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11651(@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
11652
01c52d31
MB
11653@item Y t
11654@kindex Y t (Summary)
11655@findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
11656Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11657(@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
11658
4009494e
GM
11659@end table
11660
11661
11662@node Really Various Summary Commands
11663@subsection Really Various Summary Commands
11664
11665@table @kbd
11666
11667@item A D
11668@itemx C-d
11669@kindex C-d (Summary)
11670@kindex A D (Summary)
11671@findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
11672If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
11673a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
11674article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
11675guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
11676to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
11677whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
11678some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
11679fashion.
11680
01c52d31
MB
11681@vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
11682The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
11683article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
11684include:
11685
11686@table @code
11687@item next
11688Select the next article.
11689
11690@item next-unread
11691Select the next unread article.
11692
11693@item next-noselect
11694Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
11695
11696@item next-unread-noselect
11697Move the cursor to the next unread article.
11698@end table
11699
11700If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
11701article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
11702
4009494e
GM
11703@item C-M-d
11704@kindex C-M-d (Summary)
11705@findex gnus-summary-read-document
11706This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
11707several documents into one biiig group
11708(@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
11709@code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
11710@code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
11711command understands the process/prefix convention
11712(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
11713
11714@item C-t
11715@kindex C-t (Summary)
11716@findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
11717Toggle truncation of summary lines
11718(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
11719line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
11720to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
11721
11722@item =
11723@kindex = (Summary)
11724@findex gnus-summary-expand-window
11725Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11726If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
11727
11728@item C-M-e
11729@kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11730@findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11731Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11732group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
11733
11734@item C-M-a
11735@kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11736@findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11737Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11738group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11739
11740@end table
11741
11742
11743@node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11744@section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11745@cindex summary exit
11746@cindex exiting groups
11747
11748Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11749group and return you to the group buffer.
11750
11751@table @kbd
11752
11753@item Z Z
11754@itemx Z Q
11755@itemx q
11756@kindex Z Z (Summary)
11757@kindex Z Q (Summary)
11758@kindex q (Summary)
11759@findex gnus-summary-exit
11760@vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11761@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11762@vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11763@c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11764Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11765(@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11766called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11767@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11768@code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11769process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11770group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11771
11772@item Z E
11773@itemx Q
11774@kindex Z E (Summary)
11775@kindex Q (Summary)
11776@findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11777Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11778(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11779
11780@item Z c
11781@itemx c
11782@kindex Z c (Summary)
11783@kindex c (Summary)
11784@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11785@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11786Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11787(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11788
11789@item Z C
11790@kindex Z C (Summary)
11791@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11792Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11793(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11794
11795@item Z n
11796@kindex Z n (Summary)
11797@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11798Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11799(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11800
01c52d31
MB
11801@item Z p
11802@kindex Z p (Summary)
11803@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11804Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11805(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11806
4009494e
GM
11807@item Z R
11808@itemx C-x C-s
11809@kindex Z R (Summary)
11810@kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11811@findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11812Exit this group, and then enter it again
11813(@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11814all articles, both read and unread.
11815
11816@item Z G
11817@itemx M-g
11818@kindex Z G (Summary)
11819@kindex M-g (Summary)
11820@findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11821@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11822Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11823group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11824articles, both read and unread.
11825
11826@item Z N
11827@kindex Z N (Summary)
11828@findex gnus-summary-next-group
11829Exit the group and go to the next group
11830(@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11831
11832@item Z P
11833@kindex Z P (Summary)
11834@findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11835Exit the group and go to the previous group
11836(@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11837
11838@item Z s
11839@kindex Z s (Summary)
11840@findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11841Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11842and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11843given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11844command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11845@end table
11846
11847@vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11848@code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11849with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11850(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11851
11852@findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11853@findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11854@vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11855If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11856about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11857If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11858(Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11859something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11860called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11861buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11862@code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11863summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11864
11865There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11866
11867@vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11868The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11869read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11870summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11871@code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11872this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11873other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11874neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11875both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11876
11877
11878@node Crosspost Handling
11879@section Crosspost Handling
11880
11881@cindex velveeta
11882@cindex spamming
11883Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11884read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11885posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11886several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11887by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11888heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
11889(@pxref{NoCeM}).
11890
11891Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11892separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11893@dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11894@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11895excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11896
11897@cindex cross-posting
11898@cindex Xref
11899@cindex @acronym{NOV}
11900One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11901correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11902(which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11903does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11904Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11905even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11906articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11907them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11908the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11909the cross reference mechanism.
11910
11911@cindex LIST overview.fmt
11912@cindex overview.fmt
11913To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11914in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11915@samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11916overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11917get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11918your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11919overview files.
11920
4009494e 11921If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
4b70e299
MB
11922set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11923considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
4009494e
GM
11924
11925C'est la vie.
11926
11927For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11928
11929
11930@node Duplicate Suppression
11931@section Duplicate Suppression
11932
11933By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11934article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11935(@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11936approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11937reasons.
11938
11939@enumerate
11940@item
11941The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11942is evil and not very common.
11943
11944@item
11945The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11946@file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11947
11948@item
11949You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11950different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11951
11952@item
11953You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11954@end enumerate
11955
11956I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11957well, but these four are the most common situations.
11958
11959If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11960consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11961will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11962otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11963all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11964mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11965so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11966once.
11967
11968Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11969sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11970fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11971to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11972article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11973saw the article in.
11974
11975@table @code
11976@item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11977@vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11978If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11979
11980@item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11981@vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11982If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11983make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11984However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11985session are suppressed.
11986
11987@item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11988@vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11989This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11990suppression list. The default is 10000.
11991
11992@item gnus-duplicate-file
11993@vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11994The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11995default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11996@end table
11997
11998If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11999@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
12000you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
12001the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
12002so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
12003@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
12004to you to figure out, I think.
12005
12006@node Security
12007@section Security
12008
12009Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
12010The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
12011and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
12012things to work:
12013
12014@enumerate
12015@item
12016To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
12017install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
12018to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
12019Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
12020
12021@item
12022To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
12023or newer is recommended.
12024
12025@end enumerate
12026
12027The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
12028include:
12029
12030@table @code
12031@item mm-verify-option
12032@vindex mm-verify-option
12033Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
12034@code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
12035protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
12036
12037@item mm-decrypt-option
12038@vindex mm-decrypt-option
12039Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
12040@code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
12041protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
12042
12043@item mml1991-use
12044@vindex mml1991-use
12045Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
12046@acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
12047@code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
12048deprecated.
12049
12050@item mml2015-use
12051@vindex mml2015-use
12052Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
12053@acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
12054@code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
12055deprecated.
12056
12057@end table
12058
12059By default the buttons that display security information are not
12060shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
12061@kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
12062@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
12063@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
12064permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
12065how to customize these variables to always display security
12066information.
12067
12068@cindex snarfing keys
12069@cindex importing PGP keys
12070@cindex PGP key ring import
12071Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
12072key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
12073rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
12074allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
12075through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
12076@file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
12077Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
12078Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
12079(@pxref{Using MIME}).
12080
12081@example
12082application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
12083@end example
12084@noindent
12085This happens to also be the default action defined in
12086@code{mailcap-mime-data}.
12087
12088More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
12089encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
12090(@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
12091
12092@node Mailing List
12093@section Mailing List
12094@cindex mailing list
12095@cindex RFC 2396
12096
12097@kindex A M (summary)
12098@findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
12099Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
12100add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
12101possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
12102summary buffer.
12103
12104That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
12105
12106@table @kbd
12107
12108@item C-c C-n h
12109@kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
12110@findex gnus-mailing-list-help
12111Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
12112
12113@item C-c C-n s
12114@kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
12115@findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
12116Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
12117
12118@item C-c C-n u
12119@kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
12120@findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
12121Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
12122field exists.
12123
12124@item C-c C-n p
12125@kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
12126@findex gnus-mailing-list-post
12127Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
12128
12129@item C-c C-n o
12130@kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
12131@findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
12132Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
12133
12134@item C-c C-n a
12135@kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
01c52d31 12136@findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
4009494e
GM
12137Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
12138
12139@end table
12140
12141
12142@node Article Buffer
12143@chapter Article Buffer
12144@cindex article buffer
12145
12146The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
12147one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
12148tell Gnus otherwise.
12149
12150@menu
12151* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
12152* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
12153* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
12154* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
12155* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
12156@end menu
12157
12158
12159@node Hiding Headers
12160@section Hiding Headers
12161@cindex hiding headers
12162@cindex deleting headers
12163
12164The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
12165@dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
12166
12167@vindex gnus-show-all-headers
12168There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
12169who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
12170article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
12171most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
12172through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
12173@code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
12174of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
12175article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
12176
12177Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
12178
12179@table @code
12180
12181@item gnus-visible-headers
12182@vindex gnus-visible-headers
12183If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
12184that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
12185headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
12186
12187For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
12188the article and the subject, you'd say:
12189
12190@lisp
12191(setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
12192@end lisp
12193
12194This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
12195remain visible.
12196
12197@item gnus-ignored-headers
12198@vindex gnus-ignored-headers
12199This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
12200variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
12201should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
12202hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
12203
12204For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
12205and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
12206
12207@lisp
12208(setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
12209@end lisp
12210
12211This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
12212be removed.
12213
12214Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
12215variable will have no effect.
12216
12217@end table
12218
12219@vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
12220Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
12221can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
12222variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
12223the headers are to be displayed.
12224
12225For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
12226and then the subject, you might say something like:
12227
12228@lisp
12229(setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
12230@end lisp
12231
12232Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
12233variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
12234
12235@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
12236@vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
12237You can hide further boring headers by setting
12238@code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
12239does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
12240list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
12241lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
12242from sight.
12243
12244These conditions are:
12245@table @code
12246@item empty
12247Remove all empty headers.
12248@item followup-to
12249Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
12250@code{Newsgroups} header.
12251@item reply-to
12252Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
12253the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
12254parameter is set.
12255@item newsgroups
12256Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
12257name.
12258@item to-address
12259Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
12260the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
12261@item to-list
12262Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
12263the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
12264@item cc-list
12265Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
12266the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
12267@item date
12268Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
12269old.
12270@item long-to
12271Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
12272@item many-to
12273Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
12274@end table
12275
12276To include these three elements, you could say something like:
12277
12278@lisp
12279(setq gnus-boring-article-headers
12280 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
12281@end lisp
12282
12283This is also the default value for this variable.
12284
12285
12286@node Using MIME
12287@section Using MIME
12288@cindex @acronym{MIME}
12289
12290Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
12291while people stand around yawning.
12292
12293@acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
12294while all newsreaders die of fear.
12295
12296@acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
12297of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
12298other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
12299
12300@vindex gnus-display-mime-function
12301@findex gnus-display-mime
12302Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
12303to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
12304default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
12305display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
12306
12307The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
12308@acronym{MIME} button:
12309
12310@table @kbd
12311@findex gnus-article-press-button
12312@item RET (Article)
12313@kindex RET (Article)
12314@itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
12315Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
12316(@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
12317the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
12318files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
12319object is displayed inline.
12320
12321@findex gnus-mime-view-part
12322@item M-RET (Article)
12323@kindex M-RET (Article)
12324@itemx v (Article)
12325Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
12326method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
12327
12328@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
12329@item t (Article)
12330@kindex t (Article)
12331View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
12332(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
12333
12334@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
12335@item C (Article)
12336@kindex C (Article)
12337Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
12338charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
12339
12340@findex gnus-mime-save-part
12341@item o (Article)
12342@kindex o (Article)
12343Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
12344(@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
12345
12346@findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
12347@item C-o (Article)
12348@kindex C-o (Article)
12349Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
12350the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
12351suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
12352like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
12353message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
12354(@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
12355
01c52d31
MB
12356@findex gnus-mime-replace-part
12357@item r (Article)
12358@kindex r (Article)
12359Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
12360external body refering to the file via the message/external-body
12361@acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
12362
4009494e
GM
12363@findex gnus-mime-delete-part
12364@item d (Article)
12365@kindex d (Article)
12366Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
12367information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
12368(@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
12369
01c52d31
MB
12370@c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
12371
4009494e
GM
12372@findex gnus-mime-copy-part
12373@item c (Article)
12374@kindex c (Article)
12375Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
01c52d31
MB
12376(@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
12377without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
12378charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
12379@ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
4009494e
GM
12380@file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
12381@code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
12382Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
12383
12384@findex gnus-mime-print-part
12385@item p (Article)
12386@kindex p (Article)
12387Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
12388command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
12389@file{.mailcap} file.
12390
12391@findex gnus-mime-inline-part
12392@item i (Article)
12393@kindex i (Article)
12394Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
9b3ebcb6 12395(@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
4009494e
GM
12396the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
12397do semi-manual charset stuff (see
12398@code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
01c52d31
MB
12399Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
12400automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
12401@code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
12402Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
4009494e
GM
12403
12404@findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
12405@item E (Article)
12406@kindex E (Article)
12407View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
12408viewer is available, use an external viewer
12409(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
12410
12411@findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
12412@item e (Article)
12413@kindex e (Article)
12414View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
12415(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
12416
12417@findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
12418@item | (Article)
12419@kindex | (Article)
12420Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
12421
12422@findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
12423@item . (Article)
12424@kindex . (Article)
12425Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
12426(@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
12427
12428@end table
12429
12430Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
12431determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
12432@acronym{MIME} manual.
12433
12434It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
12435buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
12436group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
12437decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
12438comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
12439because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
12440try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
12441to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
12442to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
12443
12444Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
12445
12446Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
12447
12448
12449@node Customizing Articles
12450@section Customizing Articles
12451@cindex article customization
12452
12453A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
12454exist. You can call these functions interactively
12455(@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
12456called automatically when you select the articles.
12457
12458To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
12459``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
12460@code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
12461be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
12462
12463Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
12464for sensible values.
12465
12466@enumerate
12467@item
12468@code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
12469
12470@item
12471@code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
12472
12473@item
12474@code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
12475
12476@item
01c52d31
MB
12477@code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
12478
12479@item
12480@code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
4009494e
GM
12481
12482@item
12483An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
12484than this number.
12485
12486@item
12487A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
12488articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
12489regexps in the list.
12490
12491@item
12492A list where the first element is not a string:
12493
12494The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
12495predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
12496@code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
12497
12498@lisp
12499(or last
12500 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
12501@end lisp
12502
12503@end enumerate
12504
12505You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
12506to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
12507be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
12508considered to contain just a single part.
12509
12510@vindex gnus-article-treat-types
12511Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
12512want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
12513treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
12514variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
12515type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
12516controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
12517
12518@ifinfo
12519@c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
12520@c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
12521@c `i foo-bar'.
12522@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
12523@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
12524@vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
12525@vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
12526@vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
12527@vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
12528@vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
12529@vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
12530@vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
12531@vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
12532@vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
12533@vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
12534@vindex gnus-treat-date-english
12535@vindex gnus-treat-date-iso8601
12536@vindex gnus-treat-date-lapsed
12537@vindex gnus-treat-date-local
12538@vindex gnus-treat-date-original
12539@vindex gnus-treat-date-user-defined
12540@vindex gnus-treat-date-ut
12541@vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
12542@vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
12543@vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
12544@vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
12545@vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
12546@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12547@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12548@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12549@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12550@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12551@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12552@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12553@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12554@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12555@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12556@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12557@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12558@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12559@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12560@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12561@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12562@vindex gnus-treat-translate
12563@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12564@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12565@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12566@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12567@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12568@end ifinfo
12569
12570The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
12571customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
12572group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
12573possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
12574
12575@table @code
12576@item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
12577@item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
12578
12579@xref{Article Buttons}.
12580
12581@item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
12582@item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
12583@item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
12584@item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
01c52d31 12585@item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
4009494e
GM
12586@item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
12587@item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
12588@item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
12589@item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
12590@item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
12591
12592@xref{Article Washing}.
12593
12594@item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
12595@item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
12596@item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
12597@item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
12598@item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
12599@item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
12600@item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
12601
12602@xref{Article Date}.
12603
12604@item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
12605@item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
12606@item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
12607
12608@xref{Picons}.
12609
12610@item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
12611
12612@item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
12613
12614@vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
12615Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
12616is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
12617
12618@xref{Smileys}.
12619
12620@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12621@item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
12622
12623@xref{X-Face}.
12624
12625@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12626@item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12627
12628@xref{Face}.
12629
12630@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12631@item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12632@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12633@item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12634@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12635@item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12636@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12637@item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12638@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12639@item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12640@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12641@item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12642@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12643@item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12644@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12645@item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12646@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12647@item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12648@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12649@item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12650
12651@xref{Article Hiding}.
12652
12653@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12654@item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12655@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12656@item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12657@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12658@item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12659
12660@xref{Article Highlighting}.
12661
12662@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12663@item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12664@vindex gnus-treat-translate
12665@item gnus-treat-translate
01c52d31 12666@item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
4009494e
GM
12667@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12668@item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12669
12670@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12671@item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12672@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12673@item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12674@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12675@item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12676@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12677@item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12678
12679@xref{Article Header}.
12680
12681
12682@end table
12683
12684@vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12685You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12686@code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12687part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12688information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12689everything.
12690
12691
12692@node Article Keymap
12693@section Article Keymap
12694
12695Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12696article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12697buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12698buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12699buffer.
12700
12701@kindex v (Article)
12702@cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12703The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12704command or better use it as a prefix key.
12705
12706A few additional keystrokes are available:
12707
12708@table @kbd
12709
12710@item SPACE
12711@kindex SPACE (Article)
12712@findex gnus-article-next-page
12713Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12714This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12715
12716@item DEL
12717@kindex DEL (Article)
12718@findex gnus-article-prev-page
12719Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12720This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12721
12722@item C-c ^
12723@kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12724@findex gnus-article-refer-article
12725If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12726@kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12727(@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12728
12729@item C-c C-m
12730@kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12731@findex gnus-article-mail
12732Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12733given a prefix, include the mail.
12734
12735@item s
12736@kindex s (Article)
12737@findex gnus-article-show-summary
12738Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12739(@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12740
12741@item ?
12742@kindex ? (Article)
12743@findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12744Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12745(@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12746
12747@item TAB
12748@kindex TAB (Article)
12749@findex gnus-article-next-button
12750Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12751only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12752
12753@item M-TAB
12754@kindex M-TAB (Article)
12755@findex gnus-article-prev-button
12756Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12757
12758@item R
12759@kindex R (Article)
12760@findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12761Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
95838435
MB
12762(@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12763only yank the text in the region.
12764
12765@item S W
12766@kindex S W (Article)
12767@findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12768Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12769(@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12770active, only yank the text in the region.
4009494e
GM
12771
12772@item F
12773@kindex F (Article)
12774@findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12775Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
95838435
MB
12776(@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12777only yank the text in the region.
4009494e
GM
12778
12779
12780@end table
12781
12782
12783@node Misc Article
12784@section Misc Article
12785
12786@table @code
12787
12788@item gnus-single-article-buffer
12789@vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12790@cindex article buffers, several
12791If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12792(This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12793article buffer.
12794
12795@vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12796@item gnus-article-decode-hook
12797@cindex @acronym{MIME}
12798Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12799@code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12800
12801@vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12802@item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12803This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12804article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12805depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12806the contents of the article buffer.
12807
12808@item gnus-article-mode-hook
12809@vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12810Hook called in article mode buffers.
12811
12812@item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12813@vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12814Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12815@code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12816
12817@vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12818@item gnus-article-over-scroll
12819If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12820no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12821
12822@vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12823@item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12824This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12825@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12826Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12827with two extensions:
12828
12829@table @samp
12830
12831@item w
12832The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12833character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12834performed. The characters and their meaning:
12835
12836@table @samp
12837
12838@item c
12839Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12840
12841@item h
12842Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12843
12844@item p
12845Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12846hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12847security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
12848
12849@item s
12850Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12851
12852@item o
12853Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12854
12855@item e
6772c8e1 12856Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
4009494e
GM
12857
12858@end table
12859
12860@item m
12861The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12862
12863@end table
12864
12865@vindex gnus-break-pages
12866
12867@item gnus-break-pages
12868Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12869is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12870page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12871paging will not be done.
12872
12873@item gnus-page-delimiter
12874@vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12875This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12876(formfeed).
12877
12878@cindex IDNA
12879@cindex internationalized domain names
12880@vindex gnus-use-idna
12881@item gnus-use-idna
12882This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12883internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
01c52d31
MB
12884@samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12885for how to compose such messages. This requires
4009494e
GM
12886@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12887variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12888
12889@end table
12890
12891
12892@node Composing Messages
12893@chapter Composing Messages
12894@cindex composing messages
12895@cindex messages
12896@cindex mail
12897@cindex sending mail
12898@cindex reply
12899@cindex followup
12900@cindex post
12901@cindex using gpg
12902@cindex using s/mime
12903@cindex using smime
12904
12905@kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12906All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12907where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12908article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12909Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12910on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12911
12912@menu
12913* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12914* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12915* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12916* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12917* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12918* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12919* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12920* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12921* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12922@end menu
12923
12924Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12925remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12926
12927
12928@node Mail
12929@section Mail
12930
12931Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12932
12933@table @code
12934@item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12935@vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12936List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12937headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12938@code{nil} include all headers.
12939
12940@item gnus-add-to-list
12941@vindex gnus-add-to-list
12942If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12943that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12944
12945@item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12946@vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12947If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12948about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12949interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12950receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12951non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12952matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12953
12954If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12955press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12956
12957@item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12958@vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12959If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12960@code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12961useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12962
12963@end table
12964
12965
12966@node Posting Server
12967@section Posting Server
12968
12969When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12970(extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12971
12972Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12973
12974It can be quite complicated.
12975
12976@vindex gnus-post-method
12977When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12978(@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12979Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12980reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12981groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12982you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12983want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12984fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12985@code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12986
12987@lisp
12988(setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12989@end lisp
12990
12991Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12992this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12993can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12994the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12995
12996If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12997Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12998
12999You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
13000If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
13001for posting.
13002
13003Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
13004you can set this variable to @code{native}.
13005
d82cf70b
MB
13006@vindex message-send-mail-function
13007When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
13008variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
13009value suitable for your system.
13010@xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
13011information.
4009494e
GM
13012
13013@node POP before SMTP
13014@section POP before SMTP
13015@cindex pop before smtp
13016@findex message-smtpmail-send-it
13017@findex mail-source-touch-pop
13018
13019Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
13020authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
13021mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
13022a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
13023@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13024
13025@lisp
13026(setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
13027(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
13028@end lisp
13029
13030@noindent
13031It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
13032whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
13033does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
13034@code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
13035Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
13036@code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
13037set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
13038correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
13039
13040If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
13041@code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
13042@code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
13043used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
13044is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
13045mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
13046
13047@lisp
13048(setq mail-source-primary-source
13049 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13050 :password "secret"))
13051@end lisp
13052
13053@noindent
13054Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
13055@acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
13056
13057@lisp
13058(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
13059 (lambda ()
13060 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
13061 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13062 :password "secret")))
13063 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
13064@end lisp
13065
13066@node Mail and Post
13067@section Mail and Post
13068
13069Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
13070posting:
13071
13072@table @code
13073@item gnus-mailing-list-groups
13074@findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
13075@cindex mailing lists
13076
13077If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
13078gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
13079problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
13080One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
13081(@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
13082@code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
13083really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
13084lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
13085still a pain, though.
13086
13087@item gnus-user-agent
13088@vindex gnus-user-agent
13089@cindex User-Agent
13090
13091This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
13092User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
13093symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
13094version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
13095(show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
13096configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
13097string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
13098
13099@end table
13100
13101You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
13102you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
13103spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
13104
13105@cindex ispell
13106@findex ispell-message
13107@lisp
13108(add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
13109@end lisp
13110
13111If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
13112you're in, you could say something like the following:
13113
13114@lisp
13115(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
13116 (lambda ()
13117 (cond
13118 ((string-match
13119 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
13120 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
13121 (t
13122 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
13123@end lisp
13124
13125Modify to suit your needs.
13126
01c52d31
MB
13127@vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
13128If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
13129citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
13130mode buffers.
4009494e
GM
13131
13132@node Archived Messages
13133@section Archived Messages
13134@cindex archived messages
13135@cindex sent messages
13136
13137Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
13138send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
13139store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
13140@code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
13141is the default.
13142
13143For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
13144@kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
13145Group Commands}).
13146
13147@vindex gnus-message-archive-method
13148@code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
01c52d31
MB
13149use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
13150actually being used it is expanded into:
4009494e
GM
13151
13152@lisp
13153(nnfolder "archive"
13154 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
13155 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
13156 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
13157 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
13158@end lisp
13159
01c52d31
MB
13160@quotation
13161@vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
13162Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
13163so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
13164@code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
13165@code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
13166since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
13167even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
13168afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
13169mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
13170saved method to reflect always the value of
13171@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
13172@code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
13173value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
13174@end quotation
13175
4009494e
GM
13176You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
13177@code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
13178for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
13179directory chosen, you could say something like:
13180
13181@lisp
13182(setq gnus-message-archive-method
13183 '(nnfolder "archive"
13184 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
13185 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
13186 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
13187@end lisp
13188
13189@vindex gnus-message-archive-group
13190@cindex Gcc
13191Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
13192to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
13193determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
13194
13195This variable can be used to do the following:
13196
13197@table @asis
13198@item a string
13199Messages will be saved in that group.
13200
13201Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
13202message will not be stored in the select method given by
13203@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
13204by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
13205has the default value shown above. Then setting
13206@code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
13207messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
13208value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
13209@samp{nnml:foo}.
13210
13211@item a list of strings
13212Messages will be saved in all those groups.
13213
13214@item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
13215When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
13216
13217@item @code{nil}
13218No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
13219@end table
13220
13221Let's illustrate:
13222
13223Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
13224@lisp
13225(setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
13226@end lisp
13227
13228Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
13229@lisp
13230(setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
13231@end lisp
13232
13233Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
13234@lisp
13235(setq gnus-message-archive-group
13236 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
13237 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
13238 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
13239@end lisp
13240
13241More complex stuff:
13242@lisp
13243(setq gnus-message-archive-group
13244 '((if (message-news-p)
13245 "misc-news"
13246 "misc-mail")))
13247@end lisp
13248
13249How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
13250messages in one file per month:
13251
13252@lisp
13253(setq gnus-message-archive-group
13254 '((if (message-news-p)
13255 "misc-news"
13256 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
13257@end lisp
13258
13259@c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
13260@c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
13261
13262Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
13263group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
13264you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
13265archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
13266Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
13267enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
13268group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
13269if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
13270nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
13271continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
13272
13273That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
13274different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
13275case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
13276this will disable archiving.
13277
13278@table @code
13279@item gnus-outgoing-message-group
13280@vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
13281All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
13282all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
13283you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
13284group names.
13285
13286If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
13287message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
13288current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
13289of names).
13290
13291This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
13292but the latter is the preferred method.
13293
13294@item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
13295@vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
13296If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
13297
13298@item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
13299@vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
13300If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
13301and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
13302@code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
13303non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
13304changed in the future.
13305
13306@end table
13307
13308
13309@node Posting Styles
13310@section Posting Styles
13311@cindex posting styles
13312@cindex styles
13313
13314All them variables, they make my head swim.
13315
13316So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
13317on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
13318and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
13319on?
13320
13321@vindex gnus-posting-styles
13322One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
13323variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
13324came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
13325a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
13326variable:
13327
13328@lisp
13329((".*"
13330 (signature "Peace and happiness")
13331 (organization "What me?"))
13332 ("^comp"
13333 (signature "Death to everybody"))
13334 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
13335 (organization "Emacs is it")))
13336@end lisp
13337
13338As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
13339@dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
13340``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
13341over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
13342applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
13343the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
13344@samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
13345signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
13346
13347The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
13348string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
13349If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
13350will look in the original article for a header whose name is
13351@var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
13352@var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
13353replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
13354followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
13355@code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
13356no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
13357referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
13358any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
13359said to @dfn{match}.
13360
13361Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
13362attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
13363addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
13364form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
13365@code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
13366contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
13367@var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
13368name can be one of:
13369
13370@itemize @bullet
13371@item @code{signature}
13372@item @code{signature-file}
13373@item @code{x-face-file}
13374@item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
13375@item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
13376@item @code{body}
13377@end itemize
13378
01c52d31
MB
13379Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
13380@code{message-signature-directory}.
13381
4009494e
GM
13382The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
13383this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
13384the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
13385name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
13386is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
13387
13388The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
13389zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
13390will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
13391will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
13392message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
13393are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
13394is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
13395references chars lines xref extra.
13396
13397@vindex message-reply-headers
13398
13399If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
13400meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
13401of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
13402
13403@findex message-mail-p
13404@findex message-news-p
13405
13406So here's a new example:
13407
13408@lisp
13409(setq gnus-posting-styles
13410 '((".*"
13411 (signature-file "~/.signature")
13412 (name "User Name")
13413 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
13414 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
13415 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
13416 ("^rec.humor"
13417 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
13418 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
13419 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
13420 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
13421 (signature my-news-signature))
13422 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
13423 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
13424 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
13425 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
13426 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
13427 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
13428 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
13429 (address "user@@bar.foo")
13430 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
13431 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
13432 ("nnml:.*"
13433 (From (save-excursion
13434 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
13435 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
13436 ("^nn.+:"
13437 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
13438@end lisp
13439
13440The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
13441@code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
13442if you fill many roles.
13443You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
13444@xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
13445
13446@node Drafts
13447@section Drafts
13448@cindex drafts
13449
13450If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
13451you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
13452craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
13453the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
13454other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
13455
13456Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
13457some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
13458automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
13459If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
13460article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
13461group.)
13462
13463@cindex nndraft
13464@vindex nndraft-directory
13465The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
13466@code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
13467@samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
13468@code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
13469that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
13470read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
13471
13472If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
13473to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
13474unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
13475a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
13476behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
13477be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
13478simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
13479Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
13480correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
13481
13482@c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
13483@c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
13484@c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
13485@c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
13486@c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
13487@c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
13488@c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
13489@c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
13490@c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
13491@c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
13492@c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
13493@c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
13494@c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
13495@c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
13496@c
13497@c @vindex gnus-use-draft
13498@c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
13499@c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
13500
13501@findex gnus-draft-edit-message
13502@kindex D e (Draft)
13503When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
13504draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
13505that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
13506
13507Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
13508Articles}).
13509
13510@findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
13511@kindex D s (Draft)
13512@findex gnus-draft-send-message
13513@kindex D S (Draft)
13514If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
13515doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
13516(@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
13517process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
13518command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
13519in the buffer.
13520
13521@findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
13522@kindex D t (Draft)
13523If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
13524@kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
13525as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
13526
13527
13528@node Rejected Articles
13529@section Rejected Articles
13530@cindex rejected articles
13531
13532Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
13533doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
13534@emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
13535Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
13536
13537These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
13538(Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
13539fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
13540you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
13541articles until some later time when the server feels better.
13542
13543The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
13544(@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
13545typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
13546
13547@node Signing and encrypting
13548@section Signing and encrypting
13549@cindex using gpg
13550@cindex using s/mime
13551@cindex using smime
13552
13553Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
13554@acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
13555decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
13556@code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
13557
13558@vindex gnus-message-replysign
13559@vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
13560@vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
13561Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
13562messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
13563are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
13564@code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
13565@code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
13566@code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
13567automatically encrypted messages.
13568
13569Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
13570@acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
13571signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
13572
13573@table @kbd
13574
13575@item C-c C-m s s
13576@kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
13577@findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
13578
13579Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13580
13581@item C-c C-m s o
13582@kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
13583@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13584
13585Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13586
13587@item C-c C-m s p
13588@kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13589@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13590
13591Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13592
13593@item C-c C-m c s
13594@kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13595@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
13596
13597Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13598
13599@item C-c C-m c o
13600@kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13601@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13602
13603Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13604
13605@item C-c C-m c p
13606@kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13607@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13608
13609Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13610
13611@item C-c C-m C-n
13612@kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13613@findex mml-unsecure-message
13614Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13615
13616@end table
13617
13618@xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13619
13620@node Select Methods
13621@chapter Select Methods
13622@cindex foreign groups
13623@cindex select methods
13624
13625A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13626default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13627@acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13628personal mail group.
13629
13630A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13631a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13632list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
13633@code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13634name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13635value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13636
13637One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13638we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13639
13640The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13641group as.
13642
13643For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13644@samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13645method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13646@samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13647back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13648
13649The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13650
13651@menu
13652* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13653* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13654* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13655* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13656* IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
13657* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
13658* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13659* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13660* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13661@end menu
13662
13663
13664@node Server Buffer
13665@section Server Buffer
13666
13667Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13668one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13669connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13670one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13671the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13672back end represents a virtual server.
13673
13674For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13675different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13676on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13677use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13678
13679These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13680complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13681@acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13682hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13683Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13684server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13685select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13686
13687To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13688(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13689
13690@menu
13691* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13692* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13693* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13694* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13695* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13696* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13697* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13698@end menu
13699
13700@vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13701@code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13702
13703
13704@node Server Buffer Format
13705@subsection Server Buffer Format
13706@cindex server buffer format
13707
13708@vindex gnus-server-line-format
13709You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13710@code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13711variable, with some simple extensions:
13712
13713@table @samp
13714
13715@item h
13716How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13717
13718@item n
13719The name of this server.
13720
13721@item w
13722Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13723
13724@item s
13725The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13726
13727@item a
13728Whether this server is agentized.
13729@end table
13730
13731@vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13732The mode line can also be customized by using the
13733@code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13734Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13735
13736@table @samp
13737@item S
13738Server name.
13739
13740@item M
13741Server method.
13742@end table
13743
13744Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13745
13746
13747@node Server Commands
13748@subsection Server Commands
13749@cindex server commands
13750
13751@table @kbd
13752
13753@item v
13754@kindex v (Server)
13755@cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13756The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13757command or better use it as a prefix key.
13758
13759@item a
13760@kindex a (Server)
13761@findex gnus-server-add-server
13762Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13763
13764@item e
13765@kindex e (Server)
13766@findex gnus-server-edit-server
13767Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13768
13769@item SPACE
13770@kindex SPACE (Server)
13771@findex gnus-server-read-server
13772Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13773
13774@item q
13775@kindex q (Server)
13776@findex gnus-server-exit
13777Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13778
13779@item k
13780@kindex k (Server)
13781@findex gnus-server-kill-server
13782Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13783
13784@item y
13785@kindex y (Server)
13786@findex gnus-server-yank-server
13787Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13788
13789@item c
13790@kindex c (Server)
13791@findex gnus-server-copy-server
13792Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13793
13794@item l
13795@kindex l (Server)
13796@findex gnus-server-list-servers
13797List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13798
13799@item s
13800@kindex s (Server)
13801@findex gnus-server-scan-server
13802Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13803(@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13804servers.
13805
13806@item g
13807@kindex g (Server)
13808@findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13809Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13810(@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13811a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13812
01c52d31
MB
13813@item z
13814@kindex z (Server)
13815@findex gnus-server-compact-server
13816
13817Compact all groups in the server under point
13818(@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13819nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13820hence getting a correct total article count.
13821
4009494e
GM
13822@end table
13823
13824
13825@node Example Methods
13826@subsection Example Methods
13827
13828Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13829
13830@lisp
13831(nntp "news.funet.fi")
13832@end lisp
13833
13834Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13835
13836@lisp
13837(nnspool "")
13838@end lisp
13839
13840As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13841back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13842will.
13843
13844After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13845@code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13846
13847To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13848port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13849look like then:
13850
13851@lisp
13852(nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13853@end lisp
13854
13855You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13856variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13857
13858@code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13859you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13860mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13861your private mail:
13862
13863@lisp
13864(nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13865@end lisp
13866
13867(This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13868that.)
13869
13870Here's the method for a public spool:
13871
13872@lisp
13873(nnmh "public"
13874 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13875 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13876@end lisp
13877
13878@cindex proxy
13879@cindex firewall
13880
13881If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13882server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
31fe2b00
SM
13883on the firewall machine and connect with
13884@uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13885@acronym{NNTP} server.
4009494e
GM
13886Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13887should probably look something like this:
13888
13889@lisp
13890(nntp "firewall"
31fe2b00 13891 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
4009494e 13892 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
31fe2b00 13893 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
4009494e
GM
13894@end lisp
13895
13896If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13897compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13898configuration to the example above:
13899
13900@lisp
13901 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13902@end lisp
13903
01c52d31
MB
13904See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13905an indirect connection:
fbcbb58c 13906
01c52d31
MB
13907@lisp
13908(setq gnus-select-method
13909 '(nntp "indirect"
13910 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13911 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13912 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13913 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
31fe2b00
SM
13914 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13915 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
01c52d31 13916@end lisp
4009494e 13917
fbcbb58c
KY
13918This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13919provide automatic authorization, of course.
13920
4009494e
GM
13921If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13922through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
31fe2b00 13923netcat connection to the news server as follows:
4009494e
GM
13924
13925@lisp
13926(nntp "outside"
13927 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
990e2c2f 13928 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
31fe2b00 13929 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
4009494e
GM
13930@end lisp
13931
4009494e
GM
13932
13933@node Creating a Virtual Server
13934@subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13935
13936If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13937articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13938
13939First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13940would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13941could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13942
13943Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13944
13945You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13946@samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13947Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13948will contain the following:
13949
13950@lisp
13951(nnml "cache")
13952@end lisp
13953
13954Change that to:
13955
13956@lisp
13957(nnml "cache"
13958 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13959 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13960@end lisp
13961
13962Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13963@kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13964buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13965
13966
13967@node Server Variables
13968@subsection Server Variables
13969@cindex server variables
13970@cindex server parameters
13971
13972One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13973in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13974variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13975change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13976won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13977
13978This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13979@code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13980directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13981@code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13982new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13983@code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13984variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13985variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13986manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13987
13988@lisp
13989(nnml "public"
13990 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13991 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13992 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13993@end lisp
13994
13995Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13996
13997@node Servers and Methods
13998@subsection Servers and Methods
13999
14000Wherever you would normally use a select method
14001(e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
14002when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
14003instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
14004over.
14005
14006
14007@node Unavailable Servers
14008@subsection Unavailable Servers
14009
14010If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
14011@code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
14012with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
14013will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
14014actually the case or not.
14015
14016That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
14017Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
14018@samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
14019away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
14020to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
14021attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
14022attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
14023it will regard that server as ``down''.
14024
14025So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
14026How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
14027
14028You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
14029with the following commands:
14030
14031@table @kbd
14032
14033@item O
14034@kindex O (Server)
14035@findex gnus-server-open-server
14036Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
14037(@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
14038
14039@item C
14040@kindex C (Server)
14041@findex gnus-server-close-server
14042Close the connection (if any) to the server
14043(@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
14044
14045@item D
14046@kindex D (Server)
14047@findex gnus-server-deny-server
14048Mark the current server as unreachable
14049(@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
14050
14051@item M-o
14052@kindex M-o (Server)
14053@findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
14054Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
14055(@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
14056
14057@item M-c
14058@kindex M-c (Server)
14059@findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
14060Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
14061(@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
14062
14063@item R
14064@kindex R (Server)
14065@findex gnus-server-remove-denials
14066Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
14067(@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
14068
14069@item L
14070@kindex L (Server)
14071@findex gnus-server-offline-server
14072Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
14073
14074@end table
14075
14076
14077@node Getting News
14078@section Getting News
14079@cindex reading news
14080@cindex news back ends
14081
14082A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
14083only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
14084or it can read from a local spool.
14085
14086@menu
14087* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
14088* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
14089@end menu
14090
14091
14092@node NNTP
14093@subsection NNTP
14094@cindex nntp
14095
14096Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
14097You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
14098server as the, uhm, address.
14099
14100If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
14101third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
14102to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
14103that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14104
14105The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
14106fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
14107you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
14108
14109The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
14110server:
14111
14112@table @code
14113
14114@item nntp-server-opened-hook
14115@vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
14116@cindex @sc{mode reader}
14117@cindex authinfo
14118@cindex authentication
14119@cindex nntp authentication
14120@findex nntp-send-authinfo
14121@findex nntp-send-mode-reader
14122is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
14123commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
14124default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
14125@code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
14126present in this hook.
14127
14128@item nntp-authinfo-function
14129@vindex nntp-authinfo-function
14130@findex nntp-send-authinfo
14131@vindex nntp-authinfo-file
14132This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
14133server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
14134through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
14135@code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
14136are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
14137format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
14138@code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
14139manual page, but here are the salient facts:
14140
14141@enumerate
14142@item
14143The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
14144
14145@item
14146Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
14147
14148The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
14149@samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
14150in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
14151@samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
14152deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
14153indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
14154@samp{force} is explained below.
14155
14156@end enumerate
14157
14158Here's an example file:
14159
14160@example
14161machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
14162machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
14163@end example
14164
14165The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
14166have to be first, for instance.
14167
14168In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
14169former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
14170user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
14171@samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
14172@var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
14173@samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
14174until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
14175
14176You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
14177that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
14178
14179@example
14180default force yes
14181@end example
14182
14183This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
14184previously mentioned.
14185
14186Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
14187
14188@item nntp-server-action-alist
14189@vindex nntp-server-action-alist
14190This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
14191taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
14192every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
14193
14194@lisp
14195(setq nntp-server-action-alist
14196 '(("innd" (ding))))
14197@end lisp
14198
14199You probably don't want to do that, though.
14200
14201The default value is
14202
14203@lisp
14204'(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
14205 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
14206 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
14207@end lisp
14208
14209This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
14210nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
14211
14212@item nntp-maximum-request
14213@vindex nntp-maximum-request
14214If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
14215will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
14216speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
14217waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
14218by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
14219your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
14220
14221@item nntp-connection-timeout
14222@vindex nntp-connection-timeout
14223If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
14224regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
14225responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
14226time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
14227somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
14228that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
14229connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
14230no timeouts are done.
14231
14232@item nntp-nov-is-evil
14233@vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
14234If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
14235variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
14236can be used.
14237
14238@item nntp-xover-commands
14239@vindex nntp-xover-commands
14240@cindex @acronym{NOV}
14241@cindex XOVER
14242List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
14243server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
14244"XOVERVIEW")}.
14245
14246@item nntp-nov-gap
14247@vindex nntp-nov-gap
14248@code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
14249the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
14250if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
14251article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
14252lines that you will not need. This variable says how
14253big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
14254@code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
14255network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
14256that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
14257@code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
14258
14259@item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
14260@vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
14261When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
14262specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
14263current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
14264command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
14265returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
14266in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
14267refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
14268current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
14269some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
14270having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
14271between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
14272@code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
14273to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
14274you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
14275value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
14276
14277@lisp
14278(setq gnus-select-method
14279 '(nntp "newszilla"
14280 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
14281 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
14282 @dots{}))
14283@end lisp
14284
14285The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
14286
14287@item nntp-prepare-server-hook
14288@vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
14289A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
14290
14291@item nntp-record-commands
14292@vindex nntp-record-commands
14293If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
14294@acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
14295buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
14296that doesn't seem to work.
14297
14298@item nntp-open-connection-function
14299@vindex nntp-open-connection-function
14300It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
14301be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
14302parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
01c52d31
MB
14303Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
14304in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
14305indirect ones (three pre-made).
4009494e
GM
14306
14307@item nntp-never-echoes-commands
14308@vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
14309Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
14310reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
14311to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
14312@code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
14313example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
14314@code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
14315overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
14316
14317@item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
14318@vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
14319List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
14320you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
14321not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
14322@code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
14323default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
14324
14325@item nntp-prepare-post-hook
14326@vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
14327A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
14328@code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
14329recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
14330hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
14331inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
14332
14333@lisp
14334(add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
14335@end lisp
14336
14337Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
14338INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
14339
14340@end table
14341
14342@menu
14343* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
14344* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
14345* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
01c52d31 14346* NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
4009494e
GM
14347@end menu
14348
14349
14350@node Direct Functions
14351@subsubsection Direct Functions
14352@cindex direct connection functions
14353
14354These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
14355between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
14356functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
14357(@pxref{Common Variables}).
14358
14359@table @code
14360@findex nntp-open-network-stream
14361@item nntp-open-network-stream
14362This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
14363remote system.
14364
14365@findex nntp-open-tls-stream
14366@item nntp-open-tls-stream
14367Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
14368this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
14369installed. You then define a server as follows:
14370
14371@lisp
14372;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
14373;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
14374;;
14375(nntp "snews.bar.com"
14376 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
14377 (nntp-port-number )
14378 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
14379@end lisp
14380
14381@findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
14382@item nntp-open-ssl-stream
14383Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
14384this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
14385@uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
14386then define a server as follows:
14387
14388@lisp
14389;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
14390;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
14391;;
14392(nntp "snews.bar.com"
14393 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
14394 (nntp-port-number 563)
14395 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
14396@end lisp
14397
990e2c2f
SM
14398@findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
14399@item nntp-open-netcat-stream
31fe2b00
SM
14400Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
14401program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
14402the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
4009494e
GM
14403of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
14404connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
14405@code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
14406
14407@lisp
14408(nntp "socksified"
14409 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
990e2c2f 14410 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
4009494e
GM
14411 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
14412@end lisp
14413
14414With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
14415session, which is not a good idea.
31fe2b00
SM
14416
14417@findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
14418@item nntp-open-telnet-stream
990e2c2f 14419Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
31fe2b00
SM
14420@code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
14421like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
14422not available. The previous example would turn into:
14423
14424@lisp
14425(nntp "socksified"
14426 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
14427 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
14428 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
14429 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
14430@end lisp
4009494e
GM
14431@end table
14432
14433
14434@node Indirect Functions
14435@subsubsection Indirect Functions
14436@cindex indirect connection functions
14437
14438These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
14439intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14440All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
14441the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
14442things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
14443commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14444
14445@table @code
31fe2b00
SM
14446@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
14447@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
14448Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
4009494e
GM
14449to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
14450you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
14451
31fe2b00 14452@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
4009494e
GM
14453
14454@table @code
14455@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
14456@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
14457Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
14458@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
14459
14460@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14461@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14462List of strings to be used as the switches to
14463@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
14464@samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
31fe2b00 14465@samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
4009494e
GM
14466@end table
14467
31fe2b00
SM
14468@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
14469@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
14470Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
01c52d31 14471to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
31fe2b00
SM
14472@code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
14473line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
01c52d31 14474
31fe2b00 14475@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
01c52d31
MB
14476
14477@table @code
31fe2b00
SM
14478@item nntp-telnet-command
14479@vindex nntp-telnet-command
01c52d31 14480Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
fbcbb58c 14481intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
01c52d31 14482
31fe2b00
SM
14483@item nntp-telnet-switches
14484@vindex nntp-telnet-switches
01c52d31 14485List of strings to be used as the switches to the
31fe2b00 14486@code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
01c52d31
MB
14487
14488@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
14489@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
14490Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
14491@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
14492
14493@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14494@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14495List of strings to be used as the switches to
31fe2b00
SM
14496@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
14497this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
14498the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
14499host. The default is @code{nil}.
01c52d31
MB
14500@end table
14501
31fe2b00
SM
14502Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
14503to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14504
4009494e
GM
14505@item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
14506@findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
14507Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
14508@samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
14509
14510@code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
14511
14512@table @code
14513@item nntp-via-telnet-command
14514@vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
14515Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
14516@samp{telnet}.
14517
14518@item nntp-via-telnet-switches
14519@vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
14520List of strings to be used as the switches to the
14521@code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
14522
14523@item nntp-via-user-password
14524@vindex nntp-via-user-password
14525Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
14526
14527@item nntp-via-envuser
14528@vindex nntp-via-envuser
14529If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
14530server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
14531login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
14532
14533@item nntp-via-shell-prompt
14534@vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
14535Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
14536is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
14537
14538@end table
14539
01c52d31
MB
14540Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
14541to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e
GM
14542@end table
14543
14544
14545Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
14546functions:
14547
14548@table @code
14549
14550@item nntp-via-user-name
14551@vindex nntp-via-user-name
14552User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
14553
14554@item nntp-via-address
14555@vindex nntp-via-address
14556Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
14557
14558@end table
14559
14560
14561@node Common Variables
14562@subsubsection Common Variables
14563
14564The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14565pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14566affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14567default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14568variables individually).
14569
14570@table @code
14571
14572@item nntp-pre-command
14573@vindex nntp-pre-command
14574A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14575connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14576@code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14577where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14578
14579@item nntp-address
14580@vindex nntp-address
14581The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14582
14583@item nntp-port-number
14584@vindex nntp-port-number
14585Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14586@samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14587@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14588than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14589@samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14590not work with named ports.
14591
14592@item nntp-end-of-line
14593@vindex nntp-end-of-line
14594String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14595server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
01c52d31 14596using a non native telnet connection function.
4009494e 14597
990e2c2f
SM
14598@item nntp-netcat-command
14599@vindex nntp-netcat-command
4009494e 14600Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
31fe2b00 14601@samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
4009494e 14602just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
31fe2b00 14603@samp{nc}.
4009494e 14604
990e2c2f
SM
14605@item nntp-netcat-switches
14606@vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14607A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
31fe2b00 14608is @samp{()}.
4009494e
GM
14609
14610@end table
14611
01c52d31
MB
14612@node NNTP marks
14613@subsubsection NNTP marks
14614@cindex storing NNTP marks
14615
14616Gnus stores marks (@pxref{Marking Articles}) for @acronym{NNTP}
14617servers in marks files. A marks file records what marks you have set
14618in a group and each file is specific to the corresponding server.
14619Marks files are stored in @file{~/News/marks}
14620(@code{nntp-marks-directory}) under a classic hierarchy resembling
14621that of a news server, for example marks for the group
14622@samp{gmane.discuss} on the news.gmane.org server will be stored in
14623the file @file{~/News/marks/news.gmane.org/gmane/discuss/.marks}.
14624
14625Marks files are useful because you can copy the @file{~/News/marks}
14626directory (using rsync, scp or whatever) to another Gnus installation,
14627and it will realize what articles you have read and marked. The data
14628in @file{~/News/marks} has priority over the same data in
14629@file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
14630
14631Note that marks files are very much server-specific: Gnus remembers
14632the article numbers so if you don't use the same servers on both
14633installations things are most likely to break (most @acronym{NNTP}
14634servers do not use the same article numbers as any other server).
14635However, if you use servers A, B, C on one installation and servers A,
14636D, E on the other, you can sync the marks files for A and then you'll
14637get synchronization for that server between the two installations.
14638
14639Using @acronym{NNTP} marks can possibly incur a performance penalty so
14640if Gnus feels sluggish, try setting the @code{nntp-marks-is-evil}
14641variable to @code{t}. Marks will then be stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
14642
14643Related variables:
14644
14645@table @code
14646
14647@item nntp-marks-is-evil
14648@vindex nntp-marks-is-evil
14649If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any marks files. The
14650default is @code{nil}.
14651
14652@item nntp-marks-directory
14653@vindex nntp-marks-directory
14654The directory where marks for nntp groups will be stored.
14655
14656@end table
14657
4009494e
GM
14658
14659@node News Spool
14660@subsection News Spool
14661@cindex nnspool
14662@cindex news spool
14663
14664Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14665and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14666contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14667instance.
14668
14669Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14670anything else) as the address.
14671
14672If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14673native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14674than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14675You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14676
14677@table @code
14678
14679@item nnspool-inews-program
14680@vindex nnspool-inews-program
14681Program used to post an article.
14682
14683@item nnspool-inews-switches
14684@vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14685Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14686
14687@item nnspool-spool-directory
14688@vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14689Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14690@file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14691
14692@item nnspool-nov-directory
14693@vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14694Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14695@file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14696
14697@item nnspool-lib-dir
14698@vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14699Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14700
14701@item nnspool-active-file
14702@vindex nnspool-active-file
14703The name of the active file.
14704
14705@item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14706@vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14707The name of the group descriptions file.
14708
14709@item nnspool-history-file
14710@vindex nnspool-history-file
14711The name of the news history file.
14712
14713@item nnspool-active-times-file
14714@vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14715The name of the active date file.
14716
14717@item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14718@vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14719If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14720that it finds.
14721
14722@item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14723@vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14724@cindex sed
14725If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14726relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14727@code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14728there.
14729
14730@end table
14731
14732
14733@node Getting Mail
14734@section Getting Mail
14735@cindex reading mail
14736@cindex mail
14737
14738Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
14739course.
14740
14741@menu
14742* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14743* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14744* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14745* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14746* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14747* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14748* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14749* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14750* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14751* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14752* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14753* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14754* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14755@end menu
14756
14757
14758@node Mail in a Newsreader
14759@subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14760
14761If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14762to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14763of a culture shock.
14764
14765Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14766it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14767
14768Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14769approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14770messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14771you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14772
14773In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14774
14775Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14776deleted? How awful!
14777
14778But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14779scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14780the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14781you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14782Mail}.
14783
14784What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14785mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14786they want to treat a message.
14787
14788Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14789via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14790answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14791need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14792archived somewhere else.
14793
14794Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14795These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14796to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14797order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14798to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14799
14800The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14801but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14802or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14803
14804Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14805like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14806differently.
14807
14808Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14809that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14810to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14811not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14812instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14813
14814I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14815may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14816you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14817guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14818Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14819Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14820You Do.)
14821
14822
14823@node Getting Started Reading Mail
14824@subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14825
14826It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14827mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14828and things will happen automatically.
14829
14830For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14831mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14832
14833@lisp
14834(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14835@end lisp
14836
14837Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14838articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14839directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14840be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14841like any other group.
14842
14843You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14844
14845@lisp
14846(setq nnmail-split-methods
14847 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14848 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14849 ("other" "")))
14850@end lisp
14851
14852This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14853@samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14854mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14855last group.
14856
14857This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14858give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14859Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14860
14861
14862@node Splitting Mail
14863@subsection Splitting Mail
14864@cindex splitting mail
14865@cindex mail splitting
14866@cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14867
14868@vindex nnmail-split-methods
14869The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14870to be split into groups.
14871
14872@lisp
14873(setq nnmail-split-methods
14874 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14875 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14876 ("mail.other" "")))
14877@end lisp
14878
14879This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14880these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14881something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14882element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14883determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14884contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14885insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14886
14887@lisp
14888("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14889@end lisp
14890
14891@noindent
14892In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14893the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14894
14895The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14896called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14897argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14898mail belongs in that group.
14899
14900@cindex @samp{bogus} group
14901The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14902expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14903that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14904processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14905to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14906that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14907will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14908splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14909see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14910
14911If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14912function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14913arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14914message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14915thinks should carry this mail message.
14916
14917Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14918incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14919some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14920@code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14921
14922@vindex nnmail-crosspost
14923The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14924the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14925@code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14926that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14927
14928@vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14929@cindex crosspost
14930@cindex links
14931@code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14932the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14933links. If that's the case for you, set
14934@code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14935variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14936
14937@kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14938@findex nnmail-split-history
14939If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14940can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14941where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14942@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14943Group Commands}).
14944
14945@vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14946Header lines longer than the value of
14947@code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14948function.
14949
14950@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14951@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14952By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14953non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14954articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14955@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14956In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14957variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14958@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14959value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14960string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14961charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14962
14963@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14964By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14965specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14966(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14967@emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14968@code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14969splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14970other kinds of entries.)
14971
14972Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14973yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14974all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14975unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14976boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14977that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14978come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14979you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14980month's rent money.
14981
14982
14983@node Mail Sources
14984@subsection Mail Sources
14985
14986Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14987a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14988maildir, for instance.
14989
14990@menu
14991* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14992* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14993* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14994@end menu
14995
14996
14997@node Mail Source Specifiers
14998@subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14999@cindex POP
15000@cindex mail server
15001@cindex procmail
15002@cindex mail spool
15003@cindex mail source
15004
15005You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
15006(@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
15007
15008Here's an example:
15009
15010@lisp
15011(pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
15012@end lisp
15013
15014As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
15015element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
15016@dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
15017default values.
15018
a1da1e37
MB
15019The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
15020an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
15021@code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
15022@code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
15023a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
15024typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
15025group might look like this:
15026
15027@lisp
15028(mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
15029@end lisp
15030
15031This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
15032fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
15033
4009494e
GM
15034The following mail source types are available:
15035
15036@table @code
15037@item file
15038Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
15039
15040Keywords:
15041
15042@table @code
15043@item :path
15044The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
15045environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
15046(usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
15047
15048@item :prescript
15049@itemx :postscript
15050Script run before/after fetching mail.
15051@end table
15052
15053An example file mail source:
15054
15055@lisp
15056(file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
15057@end lisp
15058
15059Or using the default file name:
15060
15061@lisp
15062(file)
15063@end lisp
15064
15065If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
15066to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
15067You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
15068mail spool while moving the mail.
15069
15070If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
15071
15072@lisp
15073(setq mail-sources
15074 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
15075@end lisp
15076
15077The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
15078
15079@example
15080#!/bin/sh
15081# getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
15082# flu@@iki.fi
15083
15084MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
15085TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
15086rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
15087@end example
15088
15089Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
15090file you want to use.
15091
15092
15093@item directory
15094@vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
15095Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
15096when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
15097That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
15098directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
15099will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
15100to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
15101@code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
15102Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
15103if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
15104
15105@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
15106There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
15107that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
15108applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
15109
15110Keywords:
15111
15112@table @code
15113@item :path
15114The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
15115value.
15116
15117@item :suffix
15118Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
15119@samp{.spool}.
15120
15121@item :predicate
15122Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
15123The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
15124filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
15125predicate are considered.
15126
15127@item :prescript
15128@itemx :postscript
15129Script run before/after fetching mail.
15130
15131@end table
15132
15133An example directory mail source:
15134
15135@lisp
15136(directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
15137 :suffix ".prcml")
15138@end lisp
15139
15140@item pop
15141Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
15142
15143Keywords:
15144
15145@table @code
15146@item :server
15147The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
15148@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
15149
15150@item :port
15151The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
15152@samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
15153string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
15154Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
15155need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
15156
15157@item :user
15158The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
15159name.
15160
15161@item :password
15162The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
15163the user is prompted.
15164
15165@item :program
15166The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
15167should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
15168
15169@example
15170fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
15171@end example
15172
15173The valid format specifier characters are:
15174
15175@table @samp
15176@item t
15177The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
15178included in this string.
15179
15180@item s
15181The name of the server.
15182
15183@item P
15184The port number of the server.
15185
15186@item u
15187The user name to use.
15188
15189@item p
15190The password to use.
15191@end table
15192
15193The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
15194corresponding keywords.
15195
15196@item :prescript
15197A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
15198the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
15199
15200@item :postscript
15201A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
15202the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
15203
15204@item :function
15205The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
15206function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
15207mail should be moved to.
15208
15209@item :authentication
15210This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
15211and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
15212@code{password}.
15213
15214@end table
15215
15216@vindex pop3-movemail
15217@vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
15218If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
15219@code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
15220is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
15221after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
15222maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
15223believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
15224do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
15225apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
15226
15227Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
15228Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
15229name, and default fetcher:
15230
15231@lisp
15232(pop)
15233@end lisp
15234
15235Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
15236
15237@lisp
15238(pop :server "my.pop.server"
15239 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
15240@end lisp
15241
15242Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
15243
15244@lisp
15245(pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
15246@end lisp
15247
15248@item maildir
15249Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
15250at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
15251contains exactly one mail.
15252
15253Keywords:
15254
15255@table @code
15256@item :path
15257The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
15258taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
15259@file{~/Maildir/}.
15260@item :subdirs
15261The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
15262@samp{("new" "cur")}.
15263
15264@c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
15265@c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
15266@c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
15267@c below.
15268
15269You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
15270from locking problems).
15271
15272@end table
15273
15274Two example maildir mail sources:
15275
15276@lisp
15277(maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
15278 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
15279@end lisp
15280
15281@lisp
15282(maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
15283 :subdirs ("new"))
15284@end lisp
15285
15286@item imap
15287Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
15288@acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
15289with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
15290to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
15291@acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
15292
15293Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
15294may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
15295
15296Keywords:
15297
15298@table @code
15299@item :server
15300The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
15301@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
15302
15303@item :port
15304The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
15305@samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
15306
15307@item :user
15308The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
15309name.
15310
15311@item :password
15312The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
15313prompted.
15314
15315@item :stream
15316What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
15317symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
15318@samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
15319@samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
15320
15321@item :authentication
15322Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
15323one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
15324this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
15325@samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
15326
15327@item :program
15328When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
15329mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
15330@code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
15331
15332@example
15333ssh %s imapd
15334@end example
15335
01c52d31
MB
15336Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
15337don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
15338specifier characters are:
4009494e
GM
15339
15340@table @samp
15341@item s
15342The name of the server.
15343
15344@item l
15345User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
15346
15347@item p
15348The port number of the server.
15349@end table
15350
15351The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
15352corresponding keywords.
15353
15354@item :mailbox
15355The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
d55fe5bb 15356which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
4009494e
GM
15357
15358@item :predicate
15359The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
15360UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
15361sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
15362articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
15363Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
15364complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
15365
15366@item :fetchflag
15367How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
15368will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
15369would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
15370but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
15371
15372@item :dontexpunge
15373If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
15374mailbox after finishing the fetch.
15375
15376@end table
15377
15378An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
15379
15380@lisp
15381(imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
15382 :stream kerberos4
15383 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
15384@end lisp
15385
15386@item webmail
15387Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
15388@uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
15389@uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
15390
15391NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
15392required for url "4.0pre.46".
15393
15394WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
15395
15396Keywords:
15397
15398@table @code
15399@item :subtype
15400The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
15401alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
15402
15403@item :user
15404The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
15405name.
15406
15407@item :password
15408The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
15409prompted.
15410
15411@item :dontexpunge
15412If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
15413trash folder after finishing the fetch.
15414
15415@end table
15416
15417An example webmail source:
15418
15419@lisp
15420(webmail :subtype 'hotmail
15421 :user "user-name"
15422 :password "secret")
15423@end lisp
a1da1e37
MB
15424
15425@item group
15426Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
15427@xref{Group Parameters}.
15428
4009494e
GM
15429@end table
15430
15431@table @dfn
15432@item Common Keywords
15433Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
15434
15435Keywords:
15436
15437@table @code
15438@item :plugged
15439If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
15440use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
15441example:
15442
15443@lisp
15444(setq mail-sources
15445 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
15446 :suffix ""
15447 :plugged t)))
15448@end lisp
15449
15450Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
15451useful when you use local mail and news.
15452
15453@end table
15454@end table
15455
15456@subsubsection Function Interface
15457
15458Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15459For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15460the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15461consider the following mail-source setting:
15462
15463@lisp
15464(setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15465 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15466@end lisp
15467
15468While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15469is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15470@code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15471@code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15472and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15473
15474See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15475
15476
15477@node Mail Source Customization
15478@subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15479
15480The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15481fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15482variables.
15483
15484@table @code
15485@item mail-source-crash-box
15486@vindex mail-source-crash-box
15487File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15488@file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15489
37a68866 15490@cindex Incoming*
4009494e
GM
15491@item mail-source-delete-incoming
15492@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15493If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15494@code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15495files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
37a68866
MB
15496(the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15497set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
4009494e 15498@code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
2b968687
MB
15499@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15500and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
4009494e
GM
15501
15502@item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15503@vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15504If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15505files. This variable only applies when
15506@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15507
15508@item mail-source-ignore-errors
15509@vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15510If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15511
15512@item mail-source-directory
15513@vindex mail-source-directory
15514Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15515default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15516is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15517@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15518
15519@item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15520@vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15521Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15522@file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15523@file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15524relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15525number.
15526
15527@item mail-source-default-file-modes
15528@vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15529All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
15530
15531@item mail-source-movemail-program
15532@vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15533If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15534@code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15535
15536@end table
15537
15538
15539@node Fetching Mail
15540@subsubsection Fetching Mail
15541
15542@vindex mail-sources
4009494e
GM
15543The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15544@code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15545(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15546
b890d447
MB
15547If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15548fetch mail by themselves.
4009494e
GM
15549
15550If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15551@acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15552
15553@lisp
15554(setq mail-sources
15555 '((file)
15556 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15557 :password "secret")))
15558@end lisp
15559
15560Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15561
15562@lisp
15563(setq mail-sources
15564 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15565 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15566 :user "user-name"
15567 :port "pop3"
15568 :password "secret")))
15569@end lisp
15570
15571
15572When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15573inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15574mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15575invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15576pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15577shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15578
15579
15580
15581@node Mail Back End Variables
15582@subsection Mail Back End Variables
15583
15584These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15585mail back ends.
15586
15587@table @code
15588@vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15589@item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15590The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15591use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15592
15593@vindex nnmail-split-hook
15594@item nnmail-split-hook
15595@findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15596@cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15597@cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15598Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15599just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15600free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15601is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15602in the buffer will show up in any files.
15603@code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15604to this hook.
15605
15606@vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15607@vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15608@item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15609@itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15610These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15611mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15612starting to handle the new mail) and
15613@code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15614is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15615default file modes the new mail files get:
15616
15617@lisp
15618(add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15619 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
15620
15621(add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15622 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
15623@end lisp
15624
15625@item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15626@vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15627If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15628names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15629(assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15630@code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15631the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15632
15633@item nnmail-delete-file-function
15634@vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15635@findex delete-file
15636Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15637
15638@item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15639@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15640If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15641the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15642discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15643
15644@item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15645@vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15646This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15647Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15648recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15649
15650This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15651(@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15652@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15653
15654@end table
15655
15656
15657@node Fancy Mail Splitting
15658@subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15659@cindex mail splitting
15660@cindex fancy mail splitting
15661
15662@vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15663@findex nnmail-split-fancy
15664If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15665doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15666@code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15667play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15668
15669Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15670
15671@lisp
15672;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15673;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15674;; @r{from real errors.}
15675(| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15676 "mail.misc"))
15677 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15678 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15679 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15680 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15681 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15682 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15683 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15684 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15685 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15686 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15687 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15688 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15689 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15690 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15691 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15692 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15693 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15694 "misc.misc")
15695@end lisp
15696
15697This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15698(possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15699splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15700
15701@table @code
15702
15703@item group
15704If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15705regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15706
15707@c Don't fold this line.
15708@item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15709The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15710first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15711@var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15712@var{split}.
15713
15714If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15715@var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15716@var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15717@var{split} is processed.
15718
15719The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15720non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15721variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15722be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15723
15724@item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15725If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15726bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15727@var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15728stored in one or more groups.
15729
15730@item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15731If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15732process all @var{split}s in the list.
15733
15734@item junk
15735If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15736this message. Use with extreme caution.
15737
15738@item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15739If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15740second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15741arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15742
15743@cindex body split
15744For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15745body of the messages:
15746
15747@lisp
15748(defun split-on-body ()
15749 (save-excursion
15750 (save-restriction
15751 (widen)
15752 (goto-char (point-min))
15753 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15754 "string.group"))))
15755@end lisp
15756
b890d447
MB
15757The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15758@var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15759after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
23f87bed 15760above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
4009494e
GM
15761not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15762@code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15763(@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
15764
15765@item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15766If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15767@var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15768function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15769should return a split.
15770
15771@item nil
15772If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15773
15774@end table
15775
15776In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15777
15778Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15779according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15780@var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15781which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15782for example,
15783
15784@example
15785(any "joe" "joemail")
15786@end example
15787
15788@noindent
15789messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15790in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15791of the following three ways:
15792
15793@enumerate
15794@item
15795@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15796You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15797to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15798match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15799words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15800@code{nil}.
15801
15802Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15803
15804@item
15805@var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15806a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15807in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15808@code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15809@code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15810
15811@item
15812You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15813@samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15814section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15815are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15816@code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15817ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15818non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15819@end enumerate
15820
15821@vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15822@var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15823they are expanded as specified by the variable
15824@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15825where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15826contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15827@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15828
15829@table @code
15830@item from
15831Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15832@item to
15833Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15834@samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15835@item any
15836Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15837@end table
15838
15839@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15840@code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15841when all this splitting is performed.
15842
15843If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15844information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15845substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15846
15847@example
15848(any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15849@end example
15850
15851In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15852will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15853
15854If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15855matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15856up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15857groupings 1 through 9.
15858
15859@vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15860Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15861lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15862Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15863groups when users send to an address using different case
15864(i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15865is @code{t}.
15866
15867@findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15868@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15869split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15870you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15871boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15872working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15873string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15874messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15875it once per thread.
15876
15877To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15878and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15879value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15880using the colon feature, like so:
15881@lisp
15882(setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15883 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15884 nnmail-split-fancy
15885 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15886 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15887 ))
15888@end lisp
15889
15890This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15891non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15892in the file specified by the variable
15893@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15894(the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15895invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15896at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15897and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15898for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15899corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15900@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15901recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15902somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15903still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15904300 kBytes in size.)
15905@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15906When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15907also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15908messages goes into the new group.
15909
15910Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15911want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15912outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15913@code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15914Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15915``outgoing'' group.
15916
15917
15918@node Group Mail Splitting
15919@subsection Group Mail Splitting
15920@cindex mail splitting
15921@cindex group mail splitting
15922
15923@findex gnus-group-split
15924If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15925maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15926You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15927parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15928@code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15929for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15930from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15931@code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15932
15933Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15934splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15935parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15936rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15937
15938All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15939@code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15940the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15941@code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15942matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15943group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15944@code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15945
15946If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15947parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15948parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15949this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15950@code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15951@code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15952@code{gnus-group-split}.
15953
15954@vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15955@code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15956by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15957group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15958group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15959some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15960that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15961often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15962complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15963may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15964personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15965element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15966with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15967
15968It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15969been defined:
15970
15971@example
15972nnml:mail.bar:
15973((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15974 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15975nnml:mail.foo:
15976((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15977 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15978 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15979 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15980nnml:mail.others:
15981((split-spec . catch-all))
15982@end example
15983
15984Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15985behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15986@code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15987
15988@lisp
15989(| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15990 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15991 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15992 "mail.others")
15993@end lisp
15994
15995@findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15996If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15997may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15998splits like this:
15999
16000@lisp
16001(: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
16002@end lisp
16003
16004@var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
16005parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
16006@var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
16007single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
16008fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
16009If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
16010empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
16011Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
16012this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
16013
16014@findex gnus-group-split-setup
16015Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
16016slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
16017But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
16018used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
16019sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
16020@code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
16021@code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
16022scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
16023
16024@findex gnus-group-split-update
16025However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
16026@code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
16027@code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
16028automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
16029you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
16030
16031@lisp
16032(gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
16033@end lisp
16034
16035If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
16036will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
16037have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
16038don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
16039@code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
16040value.
16041
16042@vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
16043Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
16044by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
16045@code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
16046
16047@node Incorporating Old Mail
16048@subsection Incorporating Old Mail
16049@cindex incorporating old mail
16050@cindex import old mail
16051
16052Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
16053you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
16054back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
16055your mail groups.
16056
16057Doing so can be quite easy.
16058
16059To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
16060(@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
16061satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
16062file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
16063your @code{nnml} groups.
16064
16065Here's how:
16066
16067@enumerate
16068@item
16069Go to the group buffer.
16070
16071@item
16072Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
16073@code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
16074
16075@item
16076Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
16077
16078@item
16079Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
16080(@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
16081
16082@item
16083Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
16084@samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
16085@end enumerate
16086
16087All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
16088all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
16089have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
16090deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
16091sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
16092
16093Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
16094back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
16095using the new mail back end.
16096
16097
16098@node Expiring Mail
16099@subsection Expiring Mail
16100@cindex article expiry
16101@cindex expiring mail
16102
16103Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
16104you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
16105different approach to mail reading.
16106
16107Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
16108a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
16109actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
16110mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
16111fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
16112Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
16113course.
16114
16115To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
16116articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
16117that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
16118will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
16119deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
16120more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
16121will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
16122repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
16123NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
16124
16125You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
16126two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
16127with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
16128for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
16129considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
16130the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
16131@samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
16132expirable.
16133
16134When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
16135who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
16136and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
16137(@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
16138into its own group.)
16139
16140Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
16141answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
16142advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
16143the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
16144between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
16145only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
16146total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
16147Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
16148scoring.
16149
16150@vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
16151Groups that match the regular expression
16152@code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
16153read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
16154expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
16155
16156By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
16157articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
16158before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
16159automatically, you can put something like the following in your
16160@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
16161
16162@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
16163@lisp
16164(remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
16165 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
16166(add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
16167@end lisp
16168
16169Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
16170articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
16171will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
16172articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
16173mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
16174
16175Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
16176articles you have read to disappear after a while:
16177
16178@lisp
16179(setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
16180 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
16181@end lisp
16182
16183Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
16184@code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
16185
16186If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
16187auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
16188don't really mix very well.
16189
16190@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
16191The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
16192expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
16193message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
16194days.
16195
16196Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
16197are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
16198have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
16199expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
16200everywhere else:
16201
16202@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16203@lisp
16204(setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16205 (lambda (group)
16206 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
16207 31)
16208 ((string= group "mail.junk")
16209 1)
16210 ((string= group "important")
16211 'never)
16212 (t
16213 6))))
16214@end lisp
16215
16216The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
16217names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
16218
16219The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
16220@code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
16221necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
16222@code{never}.
16223
16224You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
16225change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
16226
16227@vindex nnmail-expiry-target
16228The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
16229However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
16230to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
16231@code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
16232parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
16233all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
16234parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
16235string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
16236moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
16237the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
16238from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
16239name or @code{delete}.
16240
16241Here's an example for specifying a group name:
16242@lisp
16243(setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
16244@end lisp
16245
16246@findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
16247@vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
16248Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
16249expire mail to groups according to the variable
16250@code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
16251
16252@lisp
16253 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
16254 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
16255 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
16256 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
16257 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
16258@end lisp
16259
16260With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
16261header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
16262get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
16263From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
16264to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
16265@code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
16266
16267@vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
16268If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
16269expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
16270easier for procmail users.
16271
16272@vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
16273By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
16274articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
16275parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
16276articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
16277caution. Even more dangerous is the
16278@code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
16279this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
16280which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
16281will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
16282crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
16283wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
16284@emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
16285with! So there!
16286
16287Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
16288
16289@vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
16290If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
16291commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
16292auto-expire turned on.
16293
16294
16295@node Washing Mail
16296@subsection Washing Mail
16297@cindex mail washing
16298@cindex list server brain damage
16299@cindex incoming mail treatment
16300
16301Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
16302really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
16303prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
16304end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
16305Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
16306considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
16307
16308Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
16309} to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
16310be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
16311laugh.
16312
16313Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
16314displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
16315storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
16316various functions that can be put in these hooks.
16317
16318@table @code
16319@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
16320@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
16321This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
16322grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
16323the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
16324
16325@table @code
16326@item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
16327@findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
16328Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
16329Emacs running on MS machines.
16330
16331@end table
16332
16333@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
16334@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
16335This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
16336cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
16337
16338@table @code
16339@item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
16340@findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
16341Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
16342headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
16343
16344(Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
16345messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
16346of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
16347rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
16348into a feature by documenting it.)
16349
16350@item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16351@findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16352Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
16353beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
16354people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
16355strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
16356also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
16357@code{\\(..\\)}.
16358
16359For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
16360@samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
16361
16362@lisp
16363(setq nnmail-list-identifiers
16364 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
16365@end lisp
16366
16367This can also be done non-destructively with
16368@code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
16369
16370@item nnmail-remove-tabs
16371@findex nnmail-remove-tabs
16372Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
16373
01c52d31
MB
16374@item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16375@findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16376@c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
4009494e 16377@cindex Eudora
01c52d31
MB
16378@cindex Pegasus
16379Some mail user agents (e.g. Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
16380@code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
16381function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
16382contain a line matching the regular expression
16383@code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
4009494e
GM
16384
16385@end table
16386
16387@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16388@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16389This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
16390include:
16391
16392@table @code
16393@item article-de-quoted-unreadable
16394@findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
16395Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
16396
16397@end table
16398@end table
16399
16400
16401@node Duplicates
16402@subsection Duplicates
16403
16404@vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
16405@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
16406@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
16407@cindex duplicate mails
16408If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
16409receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
16410@code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
16411this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
16412@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
16413default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
16414there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
16415variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
16416stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
16417@code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
16418default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
16419will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
16420that this is a duplicate of a different message.
16421
16422This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
16423will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
16424the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
16425@code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
16426
16427You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
16428@code{nil}.
16429
16430If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
16431@dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16432methods:
16433
16434@lisp
16435(setq nnmail-split-fancy
16436 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16437 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16438 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16439 (any mail "mail.misc")
16440 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16441 [...] ))
16442@end lisp
16443@noindent
16444Or something like:
16445@lisp
16446(setq nnmail-split-methods
16447 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16448 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16449 [...]))
16450@end lisp
16451
16452Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16453with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16454@code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16455using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16456received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16457
16458
16459@node Not Reading Mail
16460@subsection Not Reading Mail
16461
16462If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16463habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16464be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16465
16466If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16467@code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16468mail, which should help.
16469
16470@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16471@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16472@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16473@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16474@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16475This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16476happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
16477file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16478variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16479the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16480group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16481
16482All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16483narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16484incoming mail.
16485
16486
16487@node Choosing a Mail Back End
16488@subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16489
16490Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16491file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16492depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16493
16494There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16495back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16496(because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16497Spool}).
16498
16499@menu
16500* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16501* Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
16502* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16503* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16504* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16505* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16506* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16507@end menu
16508
16509
16510@node Unix Mail Box
16511@subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16512@cindex nnmbox
16513@cindex unix mail box
16514
16515@vindex nnmbox-active-file
16516@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16517The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16518mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16519which group it belongs in.
16520
16521Virtual server settings:
16522
16523@table @code
16524@item nnmbox-mbox-file
16525@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16526The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16527@file{~/mbox}.
16528
16529@item nnmbox-active-file
16530@vindex nnmbox-active-file
16531The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16532@file{~/.mbox-active}.
16533
16534@item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16535@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16536If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16537into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16538@end table
16539
16540
16541@node Rmail Babyl
16542@subsubsection Rmail Babyl
16543@cindex nnbabyl
16544@cindex Rmail mbox
16545
16546@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16547@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16548The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
16549mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
16550mail article to say which group it belongs in.
16551
16552Virtual server settings:
16553
16554@table @code
16555@item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16556@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16557The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16558
16559@item nnbabyl-active-file
16560@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16561The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
16562@file{~/.rmail-active}
16563
16564@item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16565@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16566If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16567@code{t}
16568@end table
16569
16570
16571@node Mail Spool
16572@subsubsection Mail Spool
16573@cindex nnml
16574@cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16575
16576The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16577format. It should be used with some caution.
16578
16579@vindex nnml-directory
16580If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16581one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16582directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16583variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16584
16585You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16586care of all that.
16587
16588If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16589in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16590own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16591weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16592having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16593shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16594know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16595to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16596
16597@code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16598splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16599@acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16600fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16601
16602@cindex self contained nnml servers
16603@cindex marks
16604When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
16605servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
16606similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
16607proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
01c52d31 16608for a group are usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
4009494e
GM
16609@code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
16610Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
16611to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
16612directory).
16613
16614If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
16615up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
16616them next time it starts.
16617
16618Virtual server settings:
16619
16620@table @code
16621@item nnml-directory
16622@vindex nnml-directory
16623All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16624default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16625is @file{~/Mail}).
16626
16627@item nnml-active-file
16628@vindex nnml-active-file
16629The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16630@file{~/Mail/active}.
16631
16632@item nnml-newsgroups-file
16633@vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16634The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16635Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16636
16637@item nnml-get-new-mail
16638@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16639If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16640@code{t}.
16641
16642@item nnml-nov-is-evil
16643@vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16644If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16645default is @code{nil}.
16646
16647@item nnml-nov-file-name
16648@vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16649The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16650
16651@item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16652@vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16653Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16654
16655@item nnml-marks-is-evil
16656@vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
16657If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
16658default is @code{nil}.
16659
16660@item nnml-marks-file-name
16661@vindex nnml-marks-file-name
16662The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
16663
16664@item nnml-use-compressed-files
16665@vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16666If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
01c52d31
MB
16667files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16668(@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16669If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16670as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16671to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16672equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16673
16674@item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16675@vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16676Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16677bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16678if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
4009494e
GM
16679
16680@end table
16681
16682@findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16683If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16684whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16685nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16686entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16687might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16688functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16689Commands}).
16690
16691
16692@node MH Spool
16693@subsubsection MH Spool
16694@cindex nnmh
16695@cindex mh-e mail spool
16696
16697@code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16698@acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16699file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16700@code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16701for.
16702
16703Virtual server settings:
16704
16705@table @code
16706@item nnmh-directory
16707@vindex nnmh-directory
16708All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16709default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16710@file{~/Mail})
16711
16712@item nnmh-get-new-mail
16713@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16714If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16715@code{t}.
16716
16717@item nnmh-be-safe
16718@vindex nnmh-be-safe
16719If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16720sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16721they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16722setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16723use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16724have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16725@end table
16726
16727
16728@node Maildir
16729@subsubsection Maildir
16730@cindex nnmaildir
16731@cindex maildir
16732
16733@code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16734corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16735@uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16736@uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16737also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16738within a maildir.
16739
16740Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16741reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16742your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16743configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16744can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16745configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16746that appear as group in Gnus.
16747
16748@code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16749never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16750corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16751
16752@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16753maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16754another, and you will keep your marks.
16755
16756Virtual server settings:
16757
16758@table @code
16759@item directory
16760For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16761you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16762it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16763choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16764will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16765filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16766in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16767scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16768the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16769@code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16770
16771The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16772which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16773the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16774only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16775server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16776don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16777optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16778@code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16779use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16780if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16781value.
16782
16783@item target-prefix
16784This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16785@code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16786server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16787closed.
16788
16789When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16790created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16791pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16792So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16793@code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16794the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16795@file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16796@file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16797@file{../maildirs/foo}.
16798
16799You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16800create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16801this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16802with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16803symlinks pointing to them will be).
16804
16805As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16806then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16807@code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16808cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16809@code{force} argument.
16810
16811@item directory-files
16812This should be a function with the same interface as
16813@code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16814used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16815parameter is optional; the default is
16816@code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16817@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16818@code{directory-files} otherwise.
16819(@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16820server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16821scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16822
16823@item get-new-mail
16824If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16825maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16826the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16827@code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16828value is @code{nil}.
16829
16830Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16831an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16832that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16833different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16834remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16835@end table
16836
16837@subsubsection Group parameters
16838
16839@code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16840all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16841default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16842one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16843functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16844you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16845another back end.
16846
16847If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16848is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16849original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16850evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16851different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16852back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16853numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16854@code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16855quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16856
16857@table @code
16858@item expire-age
16859An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16860before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16861articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16862@code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16863@code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16864@code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16865and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16866wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
1686760 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16868An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16869modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16870delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16871article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16872
16873@item expire-group
16874If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16875@example
16876"backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16877@end example
16878and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16879to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16880before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16881group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16882was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16883destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16884the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16885you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16886article. So that form can refer to
16887@code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16888article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16889does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16890@code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16891
16892@item read-only
16893If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16894in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16895from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16896@file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16897cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16898@file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16899containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16900maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16901a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16902have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16903contain extra copies of the articles.
16904
16905@item directory-files
16906A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16907used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16908group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16909server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16910
16911@item distrust-Lines:
16912If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16913article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16914@code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16915
16916@item always-marks
16917A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16918Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16919say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16920marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16921feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16922in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16923
16924@item never-marks
16925A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16926Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16927say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16928stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16929@code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16930probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16931abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16932
16933@item nov-cache-size
16934An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16935speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16936for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16937worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16938parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16939the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16940The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16941and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16942that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16943that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16944@code{read}, plus a little extra.
16945@end table
16946
16947@subsubsection Article identification
16948Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16949Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16950contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16951@code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16952the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16953identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16954@file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16955about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16956available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16957request the article in the summary buffer.
16958
16959@subsubsection NOV data
16960An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16961to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16962@code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16963@code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16964need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16965when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16966force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16967single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16968file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16969assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16970with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16971
16972@subsubsection Article marks
16973An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16974@code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16975When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16976looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16977asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16978creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16979rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16980links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16981
16982You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16983@file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16984your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16985remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16986this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16987it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16988type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16989@kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16990pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16991
16992
16993@node Mail Folders
16994@subsubsection Mail Folders
16995@cindex nnfolder
16996@cindex mbox folders
16997@cindex mail folders
16998
16999@code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
17000separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
17001@code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
17002numbers and arrival dates.
17003
17004@cindex self contained nnfolder servers
17005@cindex marks
17006When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
17007servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
17008similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
17009proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
17010Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
17011with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
17012@code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
17013directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
17014backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
17015into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
17016
17017Virtual server settings:
17018
17019@table @code
17020@item nnfolder-directory
17021@vindex nnfolder-directory
17022All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
17023directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
17024(whose default is @file{~/Mail})
17025
17026@item nnfolder-active-file
17027@vindex nnfolder-active-file
17028The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
17029
17030@item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
17031@vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
17032The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
17033Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
17034
17035@item nnfolder-get-new-mail
17036@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
17037If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
17038default is @code{t}
17039
17040@item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
17041@vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
17042@cindex backup files
17043Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
17044backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
17045you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
17046following in your @file{.emacs} file:
17047
17048@lisp
17049(defun turn-off-backup ()
17050 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
17051
17052(add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
17053@end lisp
17054
17055@item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
17056@vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
17057Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
17058This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
17059extract some information from it before removing it.
17060
17061@item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
17062@vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
17063If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
17064default is @code{nil}.
17065
17066@item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
17067@vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
17068The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
17069
17070@item nnfolder-nov-directory
17071@vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
17072The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
17073@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
17074
17075@item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
17076@vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
17077If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
17078default is @code{nil}.
17079
17080@item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
17081@vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
17082The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
17083
17084@item nnfolder-marks-directory
17085@vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
17086The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
17087@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
17088
17089@end table
17090
17091
17092@findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
17093@kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
17094If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
17095@code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
17096command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
17097@code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
17098though.
17099
17100@node Comparing Mail Back Ends
17101@subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
17102
17103First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
17104low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
17105is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
17106and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
17107mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
17108
17109The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
17110typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
17111in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
17112articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
17113access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
17114area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
17115@code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
17116actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
17117via NFS).
17118
17119The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
17120simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
17121format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
17122future. Here are some high and low points on each:
17123
17124@table @code
17125@item nnmbox
17126
17127UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
17128defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
17129they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
17130@samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
17131to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
17132@samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
17133historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
17134mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
17135this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
17136area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
17137(appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
17138to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
17139fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
17140what's where.
17141
17142@item nnbabyl
17143
17144Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
17145systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
17146reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
17147was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
17148format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
17149spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
17150headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
17151Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
17152and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
17153to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
17154VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
17155perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
17156headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
17157course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
17158
17159Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
17160file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
17161look at your mail.
17162
17163@item nnml
17164
17165@code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
17166actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
17167fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
17168lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
17169and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
17170Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
17171CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
17172or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
17173@dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
17174@acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
17175due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
17176file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
17177extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
17178provided by the active file and overviews.
17179
17180@code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
17181resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
17182files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
17183tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
17184the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
17185wins big.
17186
17187It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
17188FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
17189tiny files.
17190
17191@item nnmh
17192
17193The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
17194long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
17195individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
17196is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
17197active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
17198one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
17199slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
17200
17201@item nnfolder
17202
17203Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
17204method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
17205itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
17206little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
17207a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
17208can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
17209format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
17210it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
17211out how many messages there are in each separate group.
17212
17213If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
17214messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
17215only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
17216friendly mail back end all over.
17217
17218@item nnmaildir
17219
17220For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
17221incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
17222mail back ends.
17223
17224@code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
17225differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
17226filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
17227also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
17228per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
17229@code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
17230you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
17231@uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
17232file system.
17233
17234Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
17235as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
17236This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
17237organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
17238entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
17239require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
17240thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
17241whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
17242@code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
17243@code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
17244undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
17245
17246@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
17247corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
17248them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
17249else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
17250it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
17251@code{nnmaildir}.
17252
17253@code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
17254(It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
17255and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
17256is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
17257parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
17258would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
17259removed in the future.
17260
17261Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
17262back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
17263on your file system.
17264
17265@code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
17266to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
17267
17268@end table
17269
17270
17271@node Browsing the Web
17272@section Browsing the Web
17273@cindex web
17274@cindex browsing the web
17275@cindex www
17276@cindex http
17277
17278Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
17279subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
17280eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
17281is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
17282and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
17283go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
17284even know what a news group is.
17285
17286The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
17287being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
17288they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
17289not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
17290you mad in the end.
17291
17292So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
17293to do it instead?
17294
17295Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
17296interfaces to these sources.
17297
17298@menu
17299* Archiving Mail::
17300* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
17301* Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
17302* Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
17303* Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
17304* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
17305* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
17306@end menu
17307
17308All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
17309alternatives to work.
17310
17311The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
17312work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
17313is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
17314will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
17315though, you should be ok.
17316
17317One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
17318are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
17319cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
17320Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
17321leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
17322
17323@node Archiving Mail
17324@subsection Archiving Mail
17325@cindex archiving mail
17326@cindex backup of mail
17327
17328Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
17329@code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
17330For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
17331marks is fairly simple.
17332
17333(Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
17334requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
17335though.)
17336
17337To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
17338server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
17339to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
17340similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
17341adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
17342@ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
17343might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
17344before you restore the data.
17345
17346It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
17347@code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
17348For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
17349directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
17350file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
17351this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
17352buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
17353@code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
17354is unnecessary in that case.
17355
17356@node Web Searches
17357@subsection Web Searches
17358@cindex nnweb
17359@cindex Google
17360@cindex dejanews
17361@cindex gmane
17362@cindex Usenet searches
17363@cindex searching the Usenet
17364
17365It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
17366string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
17367those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
17368the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
17369searches without having to use a browser.
17370
17371The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
17372engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
17373then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
17374group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
17375Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
17376
17377@code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
17378groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
17379each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
17380pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
17381manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
17382Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
17383@code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
17384engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
17385of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
17386header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
17387group as read.
17388
17389If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
17390won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
01c52d31 17391providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
4009494e
GM
17392make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
17393community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
17394might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
17395
17396You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
17397(try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
17398installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
17399
17400Virtual server variables:
17401
17402@table @code
17403@item nnweb-type
17404@vindex nnweb-type
17405What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
17406are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
17407@code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
17408
17409@item nnweb-search
17410@vindex nnweb-search
17411The search string to feed to the search engine.
17412
17413@item nnweb-max-hits
17414@vindex nnweb-max-hits
17415Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
17416999.
17417
17418@item nnweb-type-definition
17419@vindex nnweb-type-definition
17420Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
17421with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
17422present:
17423
17424@table @code
17425@item article
17426Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
17427understands.
17428
17429@item map
17430Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
17431
17432@item search
17433Function to send the search string to the search engine.
17434
17435@item address
17436The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
17437to.
17438
17439@item id
17440Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
17441@end table
17442
17443@end table
17444
17445
17446@node Slashdot
17447@subsection Slashdot
17448@cindex Slashdot
17449@cindex nnslashdot
17450
17451@uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
17452lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
17453let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
17454
17455The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
17456following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17457
17458@lisp
17459(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17460 '((nnslashdot "")))
17461@end lisp
17462
17463This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
17464and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
17465a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
17466groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
17467groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
17468Methods}).
17469
17470If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
17471command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
17472
17473When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
17474comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
17475particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
17476@samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
17477the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
17478directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
17479@acronym{HTML} forms.
17480
17481The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
17482
17483@table @code
17484@item nnslashdot-threaded
17485Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
17486default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
17487has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
17488threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
17489the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
17490but much, much slower than unthreaded.
17491
17492@item nnslashdot-login-name
17493@vindex nnslashdot-login-name
17494The login name to use when posting.
17495
17496@item nnslashdot-password
17497@vindex nnslashdot-password
17498The password to use when posting.
17499
17500@item nnslashdot-directory
17501@vindex nnslashdot-directory
17502Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
17503@file{~/News/slashdot/}.
17504
17505@item nnslashdot-active-url
17506@vindex nnslashdot-active-url
17507The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
17508information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
17509@samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
17510
17511@item nnslashdot-comments-url
17512@vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
17513The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
17514
17515@item nnslashdot-article-url
17516@vindex nnslashdot-article-url
17517The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
17518article. The default is
17519@samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
17520
17521@item nnslashdot-threshold
17522@vindex nnslashdot-threshold
17523The score threshold. The default is -1.
17524
17525@item nnslashdot-group-number
17526@vindex nnslashdot-group-number
17527The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
17528updated. The default is 0.
17529
17530@end table
17531
17532
17533
17534@node Ultimate
17535@subsection Ultimate
17536@cindex nnultimate
17537@cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
17538
17539@uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
17540probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
17541quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
17542information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
17543
17544The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
17545something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
17546http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
17547(not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
17548you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
17549site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
17550server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
17551
17552The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
17553
17554@table @code
17555@item nnultimate-directory
17556@vindex nnultimate-directory
17557The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
17558@file{~/News/ultimate/}.
17559@end table
17560
17561
17562@node Web Archive
17563@subsection Web Archive
17564@cindex nnwarchive
17565@cindex Web Archive
17566
17567Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
17568@uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
17569@uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
17570interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
17571groups updated.
17572
17573@findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
17574The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
17575something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
17576gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
17577www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
17578@var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
17579@var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
17580back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
17581
17582The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
17583
17584@table @code
17585@item nnwarchive-directory
17586@vindex nnwarchive-directory
17587The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
17588@file{~/News/warchive/}.
17589
17590@item nnwarchive-login
17591@vindex nnwarchive-login
17592The account name on the web server.
17593
17594@item nnwarchive-passwd
17595@vindex nnwarchive-passwd
17596The password for your account on the web server.
17597@end table
17598
17599@node RSS
17600@subsection RSS
17601@cindex nnrss
17602@cindex RSS
17603
17604Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
17605@acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
17606sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
17607presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
17608changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
17609
17610@acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
17611possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
17612
17613Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
17614system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
17615text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
17616group names.
17617
17618@kindex G R (Group)
17619Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
17620prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
17621The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
17622and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
17623
17624An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
17625the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
17626subscribe to groups.
17627
17628The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17629@code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17630names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17631coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
26b9f88d
MB
17632variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
17633information.
4009494e
GM
17634
17635The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17636@acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17637and a @samp{text/html} part.
17638
17639@cindex OPML
17640You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17641subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17642Markup Language).
17643
17644@defun nnrss-opml-import file
17645Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17646file.
17647@end defun
17648
17649@defun nnrss-opml-export
17650Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17651@acronym{OPML} format.
17652@end defun
17653
17654The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
17655
17656@table @code
17657@item nnrss-directory
17658@vindex nnrss-directory
17659The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17660@file{~/News/rss/}.
17661
17662@item nnrss-file-coding-system
17663@vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17664The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17665data files. The default is the value of
17666@code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17667in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17668
01c52d31
MB
17669@item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17670@vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17671Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17672e.g. to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17673a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17674is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17675variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17676@code{'(slash:comments)}.
17677
4009494e
GM
17678@item nnrss-use-local
17679@vindex nnrss-use-local
17680@findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17681If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17682the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17683the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17684download script using @command{wget}.
17685
17686@item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
17687Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
17688parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
17689@code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
17690,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
17691to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
17692simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
17693@samp{text/html} parts.
17694@end table
17695
17696The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17697the summary buffer.
17698
17699@lisp
17700(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17701(setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17702
17703(defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17704 (let ((descr
17705 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17706 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17707@end lisp
17708
17709The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17710summary buffer.
17711
17712@lisp
17713(require 'browse-url)
17714
01c52d31 17715(defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
4009494e
GM
17716 (interactive "p")
17717 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17718 (mail-header-extra
17719 (gnus-data-header
17720 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17721 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17722 (if url
17723 (progn
17724 (browse-url (cdr url))
17725 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17726 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17727
17728(eval-after-load "gnus"
17729 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17730 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17731(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17732@end lisp
17733
9b3ebcb6 17734Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
4009494e
GM
17735@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17736Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17737Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17738more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17739@samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17740@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17741Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17742@code{nnrss} groups:
17743
17744@lisp
17745;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17746(eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17747 '(add-to-list
17748 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17749 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17750 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17751
17752;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17753(add-to-list
17754 'gnus-parameters
17755 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17756@end lisp
17757
17758
17759@node Customizing W3
17760@subsection Customizing W3
17761@cindex W3
17762@cindex html
17763@cindex url
17764@cindex Netscape
17765
17766Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17767alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17768manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17769users.
17770
17771For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17772using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17773browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17774
17775@lisp
17776(eval-after-load "w3"
17777 '(progn
17778 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17779 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17780 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17781 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17782 (browse-url url)
17783 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17784@end lisp
17785
17786Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17787@acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17788follow the link.
17789
17790
17791@node IMAP
17792@section IMAP
17793@cindex nnimap
17794@cindex @acronym{IMAP}
17795
17796@acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
17797think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
17798server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
17799specify the network address of the server.
17800
17801@acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
17802everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
17803@acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
17804similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
17805@acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
17806is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
17807
17808If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
17809entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
17810the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
17811not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
17812
17813If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
17814entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
17815manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
17816usage explained in this section.
17817
17818A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
17819servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
17820@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
17821see below.)
17822
17823@lisp
17824(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17825 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
17826 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
17827 (nnimap "dolk"
17828 (nnimap-address "localhost")
17829 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
17830 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
17831 (nnimap "barbar"
17832 (nnimap-server-port 143)
17833 (nnimap-address "localhost")
17834 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
17835 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
17836 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
17837 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
17838 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
17839 (nnimap-stream network))
17840 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
17841 (nnimap "vic20"
17842 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
17843 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
17844 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
17845@end lisp
17846
17847After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
17848server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
17849(@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
17850(@pxref{Server Buffer}).
17851
17852The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
17853server:
17854
17855@table @code
17856
17857@item nnimap-address
17858@vindex nnimap-address
17859
17860The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
17861server name if not specified.
17862
17863@item nnimap-server-port
17864@vindex nnimap-server-port
17865Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
17866
17867Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
17868
17869@lisp
17870(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17871 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
17872@end lisp
17873
17874@item nnimap-list-pattern
17875@vindex nnimap-list-pattern
17876String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
17877This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
17878interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
17879@acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
17880@file{~/Mail/*} then.
17881
17882The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
17883REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
17884Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
17885mailbox.
17886
17887Example server specification:
17888
17889@lisp
17890(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17891 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
17892 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
17893@end lisp
17894
17895@item nnimap-stream
17896@vindex nnimap-stream
17897The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
17898will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
17899of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
17900@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
17901be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
17902
17903Example server specification:
17904
17905@lisp
17906(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17907 (nnimap-stream ssl))
17908@end lisp
17909
17910Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
17911
17912@itemize @bullet
17913@item
17914@dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
17915@samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
17916@item
17917@dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
17918@item
17919@dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
17920@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
17921@samp{starttls}.
17922@item
17923@dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
17924@samp{gnutls-cli}).
17925@item
17926@dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
17927@samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
17928@item
17929@dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
17930@item
17931@dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
17932@end itemize
17933
17934@vindex imap-kerberos4-program
17935The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
17936using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
179371.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
17938to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
17939with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
17940restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
17941indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
17942@code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
17943program.
17944
17945For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
17946needed. It is available from
17947@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
17948
17949@vindex imap-gssapi-program
17950This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
17951authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
17952sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
17953exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
17954@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
17955program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
17956tried.
17957
17958@vindex imap-ssl-program
17959For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
17960@uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
17961and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
17962SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
17963useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
17964work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
17965to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
17966
17967@vindex imap-shell-program
17968@vindex imap-shell-host
01c52d31
MB
17969For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the
17970variable @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call. Make
17971sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g., don't
17972forget to redirect the error output to the void.
4009494e
GM
17973
17974@item nnimap-authenticator
17975@vindex nnimap-authenticator
17976
17977The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
17978will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
17979
17980Example server specification:
17981
17982@lisp
17983(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17984 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
17985@end lisp
17986
17987Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
17988
17989@itemize @bullet
17990@item
17991@dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
17992external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
17993@item
17994@dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
17995@code{imtest}.
17996@item
17997@dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
17998external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
17999@item
18000@dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
18001@item
18002@dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
18003@item
18004@dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
18005@end itemize
18006
18007@item nnimap-expunge-on-close
18008@cindex expunging
18009@vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
18010Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
18011don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
18012this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
18013delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
18014nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
18015similar).
18016
18017Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
18018@code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
18019running in circles yet?
18020
18021Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
18022when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
18023variable.
18024
18025The possible options are:
18026
18027@table @code
18028
18029@item always
18030The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
18031closing a mailbox.
18032@item never
18033Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
18034the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
18035may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
18036manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
18037@item ask
18038When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
18039articles or not.
18040
18041@end table
18042
18043@item nnimap-importantize-dormant
18044@vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
18045
18046If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
18047well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
18048naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
18049articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
18050clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
18051has only one.)
18052
18053Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
18054enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
18055
18056@lisp
18057(setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
18058 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
18059(setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
18060 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
18061@end lisp
18062
18063In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
18064as ticked for other users.
18065
18066@item nnimap-expunge-search-string
18067@cindex expunging
18068@vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
18069@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
18070
18071This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
18072searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
18073@code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
18074UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
18075
18076Probably the only useful value to change this to is
18077@code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
18078messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
18079RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
18080
18081However, if @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}
18082is true, this variable has no effect since the search logic
18083is reversed, as described below.
18084
18085@item nnimap-authinfo-file
18086@vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
18087
18088A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
18089(almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
18090variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
18091@ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
18092
18093@example
18094machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
18095@end example
18096
18097Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
18098use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
18099actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
18100convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
18101@code{port imap}.
18102
18103@item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
18104@vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
18105
18106Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
18107seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
18108Courier 1.7.1 did.
18109
18110@item nnimap-nov-is-evil
18111@vindex nnimap-nov-is-evil
18112@cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
18113@cindex @acronym{NOV}
18114
18115Never generate or use a local @acronym{NOV} database. Defaults to the
18116value of @code{gnus-agent}.
18117
18118Using a @acronym{NOV} database usually makes header fetching much
18119faster, but it uses the @code{UID SEARCH UID} command, which is very
18120slow on some servers (notably some versions of Courier). Since the Gnus
18121Agent caches the information in the @acronym{NOV} database without using
18122the slow command, this variable defaults to true if the Agent is in use,
18123and false otherwise.
18124
18125@item nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
18126@vindex nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
18127@cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
18128@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
18129
18130Avoid the @code{UID SEARCH UID @var{message numbers} NOT SINCE
18131@var{date}} command, which is slow on some @acronym{IMAP} servers
18132(notably, some versions of Courier). Instead, use @code{UID SEARCH SINCE
18133@var{date}} and prune the list of expirable articles within Gnus.
18134
18135When Gnus expires your mail (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), it starts with a
18136list of expirable articles and asks the IMAP server questions like ``Of
18137these articles, which ones are older than a week?'' While this seems
18138like a perfectly reasonable question, some IMAP servers take a long time
18139to answer it, since they seemingly go looking into every old article to
18140see if it is one of the expirable ones. Curiously, the question ``Of
18141@emph{all} articles, which ones are newer than a week?'' seems to be
18142much faster to answer, so setting this variable causes Gnus to ask this
18143question and figure out the answer to the real question itself.
18144
18145This problem can really sneak up on you: when you first configure Gnus,
18146everything works fine, but once you accumulate a couple thousand
18147messages, you start cursing Gnus for being so slow. On the other hand,
18148if you get a lot of email within a week, setting this variable will
18149cause a lot of network traffic between Gnus and the IMAP server.
18150
01c52d31
MB
18151@item nnimap-logout-timeout
18152@vindex nnimap-logout-timeout
18153
18154There is a case where a connection to a @acronym{IMAP} server is unable
18155to close, when connecting to the server via a certain kind of network,
18156e.g. @acronym{VPN}. In that case, it will be observed that a connection
18157between Emacs and the local network looks alive even if the server has
18158closed a connection for some reason (typically, a timeout).
18159Consequently, Emacs continues waiting for a response from the server for
18160the @code{LOGOUT} command that Emacs sent, or hangs in other words. If
18161you are in such a network, setting this variable to a number of seconds
18162will be helpful. If it is set, a hung connection will be closed
18163forcibly, after this number of seconds from the time Emacs sends the
18164@code{LOGOUT} command. It should not be too small value but too large
18165value will be inconvenient too. Perhaps the value 1.0 will be a good
18166candidate but it might be worth trying some other values.
18167
18168Example server specification:
18169
18170@lisp
18171(nnimap "mail.server.com"
18172 (nnimap-logout-timeout 1.0))
18173@end lisp
18174
4009494e
GM
18175@end table
18176
18177@menu
18178* Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
18179* Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
18180* Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
18181* Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
18182* A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
18183* Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
18184@end menu
18185
18186
18187
18188@node Splitting in IMAP
18189@subsection Splitting in IMAP
18190@cindex splitting imap mail
18191
18192Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
18193the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
18194@acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
18195splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
18196@acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
18197
18198And it does.
18199
18200(Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
18201gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
18202Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
18203
18204Here are the variables of interest:
18205
18206@table @code
18207
18208@item nnimap-split-crosspost
18209@cindex splitting, crosspost
18210@cindex crosspost
18211@vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
18212
18213If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
18214mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
18215found will be used.
18216
18217Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
18218
18219@item nnimap-split-inbox
18220@cindex splitting, inbox
18221@cindex inbox
18222@vindex nnimap-split-inbox
18223
18224A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
18225mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
18226splitting is disabled!
18227
18228@lisp
18229(setq nnimap-split-inbox
18230 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
18231@end lisp
18232
18233No nnmail equivalent.
18234
18235@item nnimap-split-rule
18236@cindex splitting, rules
18237@vindex nnimap-split-rule
18238
18239New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
18240this variable.
18241
18242This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
18243sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
18244matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
18245Neither did I, we need examples.
18246
18247@lisp
18248(setq nnimap-split-rule
18249 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
18250 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
18251 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
18252 ("INBOX.private" "")))
18253@end lisp
18254
18255This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
18256INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
18257into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
18258
18259The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
18260replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
18261instance:
18262
18263@lisp
18264("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
18265@end lisp
18266
18267The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
18268matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
18269
18270The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
18271called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
18272containing the headers of the article. It should return a
18273non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
18274
18275Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
18276match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
18277nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
18278of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
18279unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
18280them every time you fetch new mail.)
18281
18282These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
18283end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
18284crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
18285
18286This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
18287be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
18288thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
18289
18290The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
18291
18292To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
18293even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
18294the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
18295
18296@lisp
18297(setq nnimap-split-rule
18298 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
18299 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
18300 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
18301 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
18302 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
18303@end lisp
18304
18305The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
18306may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
18307@code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
18308Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
18309rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
18310group/function elements.
18311
18312Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
18313
18314@item nnimap-split-predicate
18315@cindex splitting
18316@vindex nnimap-split-predicate
18317
18318Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
18319split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
18320
18321This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
18322your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
18323regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
18324@samp{UNDELETED}.
18325
18326@item nnimap-split-fancy
18327@cindex splitting, fancy
18328@findex nnimap-split-fancy
18329@vindex nnimap-split-fancy
18330
18331It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
18332@code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
18333splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
18334
18335However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
18336nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
18337@code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
18338rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
18339
18340Example:
18341
18342@lisp
18343(setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
18344 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
18345@end lisp
18346
18347Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
18348
18349@item nnimap-split-download-body
18350@findex nnimap-split-download-body
18351@vindex nnimap-split-download-body
18352
18353Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
18354This is generally not required, and will slow things down
18355considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
18356splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
18357
18358@end table
18359
18360@node Expiring in IMAP
18361@subsection Expiring in IMAP
18362@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
18363
18364Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
18365end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
18366Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
18367IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
18368@var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
18369follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
18370process.
18371
18372A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
18373appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
18374@code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
18375message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
18376the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
18377you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
18378your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
18379messages. Most do, fortunately.
18380
18381If expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail seems very slow, try setting the server
18382variable @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}.
18383
18384@table @code
18385
18386@item nnmail-expiry-wait
18387@item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
18388
18389These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
18390number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
18391
18392@item nnmail-expiry-target
18393
18394This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
18395@code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
18396that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
18397article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
18398
18399@end table
18400
18401@node Editing IMAP ACLs
18402@subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
18403@cindex editing imap acls
18404@cindex Access Control Lists
18405@cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
18406@kindex G l (Group)
18407@findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
18408
18409ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
18410limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
18411@acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
18412doesn't.
18413
18414To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
18415(@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
18416editing window with detailed instructions.
18417
18418Some possible uses:
18419
18420@itemize @bullet
18421@item
18422Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
18423on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
18424follow the list without subscribing to it.
18425@item
18426At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
18427``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
18428mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
18429INBOX.mailbox).
18430@end itemize
18431
18432@node Expunging mailboxes
18433@subsection Expunging mailboxes
18434@cindex expunging
18435
18436@cindex expunge
18437@cindex manual expunging
18438@kindex G x (Group)
18439@findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
18440
18441If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
18442you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
18443manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
18444
18445Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
18446delete them.
18447
18448@node A note on namespaces
18449@subsection A note on namespaces
18450@cindex IMAP namespace
18451@cindex namespaces
18452
18453The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
18454by the following text in the RFC2060:
18455
18456@display
184575.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
18458
18459 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
18460 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
18461 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
18462 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
18463
18464 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
18465 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
18466 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
18467 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
18468 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
18469 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
18470@end display
18471
18472While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
18473@acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
18474prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
18475
18476Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
18477mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
18478in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
18479created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
18480without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
18481not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
18482mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
18483you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
18484Gnus.
18485
18486See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
18487for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
18488tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
18489
18490@node Debugging IMAP
18491@subsection Debugging IMAP
18492@cindex IMAP debugging
18493@cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
18494
18495@acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
18496@acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
18497best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
18498are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
18499
18500If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
18501probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
18502exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
18503with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
18504@acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
18505critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
18506to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
18507
18508
18509@vindex imap-log
18510Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
18511disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
18512follows:
18513
18514@lisp
18515(setq imap-log t)
18516@end lisp
18517
18518This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
18519the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
18520for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
18521@code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
18522data.
18523
18524@node Other Sources
18525@section Other Sources
18526
18527Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
18528below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
18529newsgroups.
18530
18531@menu
18532* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
18533* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
18534* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
18535* SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
18536* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
18537@end menu
18538
18539
18540@node Directory Groups
18541@subsection Directory Groups
18542@cindex nndir
18543@cindex directory groups
18544
18545If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
18546it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
18547names, of course.
18548
18549This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
18550successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
18551packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
18552back end to read directories. Big deal.
18553
18554@code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
18555enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
18556@file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
18557@code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
18558directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
18559
18560@code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
18561
18562@code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
18563articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
18564whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
18565methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
18566
18567
18568@node Anything Groups
18569@subsection Anything Groups
18570@cindex nneething
18571
18572From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
18573directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
18574pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
18575true.
18576
18577When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
18578directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
18579a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
18580After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
18581@code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
18582file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
18583few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
18584just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
18585@code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
18586file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
18587elements.
18588
18589All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
18590with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
18591newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
18592in the article buffer, just as usual.
18593
18594If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
18595a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
18596traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
18597Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
18598
18599There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
18600doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
18601will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
18602are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
18603normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
18604article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
18605other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
18606be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
18607
18608Some variables:
18609
18610@table @code
18611@item nneething-map-file-directory
18612@vindex nneething-map-file-directory
18613All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
18614in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
18615
18616@item nneething-exclude-files
18617@vindex nneething-exclude-files
18618All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
18619auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
18620
18621@item nneething-include-files
18622@vindex nneething-include-files
18623Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
18624non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
18625
18626@item nneething-map-file
18627@vindex nneething-map-file
18628Name of the map files.
18629@end table
18630
18631
18632@node Document Groups
18633@subsection Document Groups
18634@cindex nndoc
18635@cindex documentation group
18636@cindex help group
18637
18638@code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
18639as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
18640
18641@table @code
18642@cindex Babyl
18643@cindex Rmail mbox
18644@item babyl
18645The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
18646
18647@cindex mbox
18648@cindex Unix mbox
18649@item mbox
18650The standard Unix mbox file.
18651
18652@cindex MMDF mail box
18653@item mmdf
18654The MMDF mail box format.
18655
18656@item news
18657Several news articles appended into a file.
18658
18659@cindex rnews batch files
18660@item rnews
18661The rnews batch transport format.
18662
18663@item nsmail
18664Netscape mail boxes.
18665
18666@item mime-parts
18667@acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
18668
18669@item standard-digest
18670The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
18671
18672@item mime-digest
18673A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
18674
18675@item lanl-gov-announce
18676Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
18677
18678@cindex forwarded messages
18679@item rfc822-forward
18680A message forwarded according to RFC822.
18681
18682@item outlook
18683The Outlook mail box.
18684
18685@item oe-dbx
18686The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
18687
18688@item exim-bounce
18689A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
18690
18691@item forward
18692A message forwarded according to informal rules.
18693
18694@item rfc934
18695An RFC934-forwarded message.
18696
18697@item mailman
18698A mailman digest.
18699
18700@item clari-briefs
18701A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
18702
18703@item slack-digest
18704Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
18705
18706@item mail-in-mail
18707The last resort.
18708@end table
18709
18710You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
18711that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
18712@code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
18713file is.
18714
18715@code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
18716it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
18717group. And that's it.
18718
18719If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
18720new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
18721that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
18722to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
18723@code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
18724(@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
18725the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
18726using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
18727file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
18728delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
18729
18730Virtual server variables:
18731
18732@table @code
18733@item nndoc-article-type
18734@vindex nndoc-article-type
18735This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
18736@code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
18737@code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
18738@code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
18739@code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
18740
18741@item nndoc-post-type
18742@vindex nndoc-post-type
18743This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
18744a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
18745and @code{news}.
18746@end table
18747
18748@menu
18749* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
18750@end menu
18751
18752
18753@node Document Server Internals
18754@subsubsection Document Server Internals
18755
18756Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
18757difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
18758looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
18759and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
18760
18761First, here's an example document type definition:
18762
18763@example
18764(mmdf
18765 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
18766 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
18767@end example
18768
18769The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
18770regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
18771variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
18772types can be defined with very few settings:
18773
18774@table @code
18775@item first-article
18776If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
18777something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
18778totally ignored.
18779
18780@item article-begin
18781This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
18782says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
18783complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
18784use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
18785
18786@item article-begin-function
18787If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
18788of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
18789
18790@item head-begin
18791If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
18792article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
18793simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
18794
18795@item head-begin-function
18796If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
18797the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
18798
18799@item head-end
18800This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
18801@samp{^$}---the empty line.
18802
18803@item body-begin
18804This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
18805to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
18806a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
18807
18808@item body-begin-function
18809If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
18810of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
18811
18812@item body-end
18813If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
18814more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
18815can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
18816
18817@item body-end-function
18818If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
18819the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
18820
18821@item file-begin
18822If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
18823before this regexp will be totally ignored.
18824
18825@item file-end
18826If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
18827regexp will be totally ignored.
18828
18829@end table
18830
18831So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
18832file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
18833few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
18834news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
18835something that's palatable for Gnus:
18836
18837@table @code
18838@item prepare-body-function
18839If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
18840will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
18841document has encoded some parts of its contents.
18842
18843@item article-transform-function
18844If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
18845meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
18846body of the article.
18847
18848@item generate-head-function
18849If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
18850understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
18851expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
18852called when requesting the headers of all articles.
18853
18854@item generate-article-function
18855If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
18856Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
18857parameter when requesting all articles.
18858
18859@item dissection-function
18860If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
18861overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
18862@code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
18863@code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
18864@code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
18865@code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
18866
18867@end table
18868
18869Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
18870digests:
18871
18872@example
18873(standard-digest
18874 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
18875 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
18876 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
18877 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
18878 (head-end . "^ ?$")
18879 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
18880 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
18881 (subtype digest guess))
18882@end example
18883
18884We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
18885text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
18886each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
18887the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
18888run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
18889
18890To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
18891@code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
18892is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
18893where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
18894The alist is traversed sequentially, and
18895@code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
18896So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
18897@code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
18898@code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
18899is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
18900correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
18901means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
18902
18903
18904@node SOUP
18905@subsection SOUP
18906@cindex SOUP
18907@cindex offline
18908
18909In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
18910are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
18911With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
18912
18913Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
18914@code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
18915transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
18916newsreaders.
18917
18918However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
18919easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
18920that interested in doing things properly.
18921
18922A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
18923and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
18924fiddly.
18925
18926First some terminology:
18927
18928@table @dfn
18929
18930@item server
18931This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
18932get news and/or mail from.
18933
18934@item home machine
18935This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
18936on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
18937
18938@item packet
18939Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
18940of packets:
18941
18942@table @dfn
18943@item message packets
18944These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
18945messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
18946default, where @var{x} is a number.
18947
18948@item response packets
18949These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
18950replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
18951default, where @var{x} is a number.
18952
18953@end table
18954
18955@end table
18956
18957
18958@enumerate
18959
18960@item
18961You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
18962use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
18963can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
18964s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
18965
18966@item
18967You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
18968
18969@item
18970You put the packet in your home directory.
18971
18972@item
18973You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
18974the native or secondary server.
18975
18976@item
18977You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
18978want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
18979
18980@item
18981You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
18982packet.
18983
18984@item
18985You transfer this packet to the server.
18986
18987@item
18988You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
18989
18990@item
18991You then repeat until you die.
18992
18993@end enumerate
18994
18995So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
18996reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
18997
18998@menu
18999* SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
19000* SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
19001* SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
19002@end menu
19003
19004
19005@node SOUP Commands
19006@subsubsection SOUP Commands
19007
19008These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
19009
19010@table @kbd
19011@item G s b
19012@kindex G s b (Group)
19013@findex gnus-group-brew-soup
19014Pack all unread articles in the current group
19015(@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
19016process/prefix convention.
19017
19018@item G s w
19019@kindex G s w (Group)
19020@findex gnus-soup-save-areas
19021Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
19022
19023@item G s s
19024@kindex G s s (Group)
19025@findex gnus-soup-send-replies
19026Send all replies from the replies packet
19027(@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
19028
19029@item G s p
19030@kindex G s p (Group)
19031@findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
19032Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
19033
19034@item G s r
19035@kindex G s r (Group)
19036@findex nnsoup-pack-replies
19037Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
19038
19039@item O s
19040@kindex O s (Summary)
19041@findex gnus-soup-add-article
19042This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
19043(@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
19044convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19045
19046@end table
19047
19048
19049There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
19050thingies:
19051
19052@table @code
19053
19054@item gnus-soup-directory
19055@vindex gnus-soup-directory
19056Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
19057@sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
19058
19059@item gnus-soup-replies-directory
19060@vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
19061This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
19062reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
19063
19064@item gnus-soup-prefix-file
19065@vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
19066Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
19067@samp{gnus-prefix}.
19068
19069@item gnus-soup-packer
19070@vindex gnus-soup-packer
19071A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
19072@samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
19073
19074@item gnus-soup-unpacker
19075@vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
19076Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
19077@samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
19078
19079@item gnus-soup-packet-directory
19080@vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
19081Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
19082
19083@item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
19084@vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
19085Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
19086@code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
19087
19088@end table
19089
19090
19091@node SOUP Groups
19092@subsubsection SOUP Groups
19093@cindex nnsoup
19094
19095@code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
19096read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
19097you can read them at leisure.
19098
19099These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
19100
19101@table @code
19102
19103@item nnsoup-tmp-directory
19104@vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
19105When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
19106directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
19107
19108@item nnsoup-directory
19109@vindex nnsoup-directory
19110@code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
19111The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
19112
19113@item nnsoup-replies-directory
19114@vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
19115All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
19116reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
19117
19118@item nnsoup-replies-format-type
19119@vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
19120The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
19121(rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
19122shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
19123
19124@item nnsoup-replies-index-type
19125@vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
19126The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
19127means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
19128
19129@item nnsoup-active-file
19130@vindex nnsoup-active-file
19131Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
19132file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
19133this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
19134@file{~/SOUP/active}.
19135
19136@item nnsoup-packer
19137@vindex nnsoup-packer
19138Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
19139is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
19140
19141@item nnsoup-unpacker
19142@vindex nnsoup-unpacker
19143Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
19144default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
19145
19146@item nnsoup-packet-directory
19147@vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
19148Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
19149@file{~/}.
19150
19151@item nnsoup-packet-regexp
19152@vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
19153Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
19154@samp{Soupout}.
19155
19156@item nnsoup-always-save
19157@vindex nnsoup-always-save
19158If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
19159
19160@end table
19161
19162
19163@node SOUP Replies
19164@subsubsection SOUP Replies
19165
19166Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
19167up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
19168more for that to happen.
19169
19170@findex nnsoup-set-variables
19171The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
19172variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
19173@sc{soup} system.
19174
19175In specific, this is what it does:
19176
19177@lisp
19178(setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
19179(setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
19180@end lisp
19181
19182And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
19183system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
19184@sc{soup}ed you use the second.
19185
19186
19187@node Mail-To-News Gateways
19188@subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
19189@cindex mail-to-news gateways
19190@cindex gateways
19191
19192If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
19193or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
19194The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
19195
19196Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
19197used to post with.
19198
19199Server variables:
19200
19201@table @code
19202@item nngateway-address
19203@vindex nngateway-address
19204This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
19205
19206@item nngateway-header-transformation
19207@vindex nngateway-header-transformation
19208News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
19209for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
19210transformation should be called, and defaults to
19211@code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
19212narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
19213gateway address.
19214
19215This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
19216@code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
19217For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
19218
19219@example
19220Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
19221@end example
19222
19223will get this @code{To} header inserted:
19224
19225@example
19226To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
19227@end example
19228
19229The following pre-defined functions exist:
19230
19231@findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
19232@table @code
19233
19234@item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
19235Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
19236@var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
19237
19238@findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
19239
19240@item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
19241Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
19242@code{nngateway-address}.
19243@end table
19244
19245@end table
19246
19247Here's an example:
19248
19249@lisp
19250(setq gnus-post-method
19251 '(nngateway
19252 "mail2news@@replay.com"
19253 (nngateway-header-transformation
19254 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
19255@end lisp
19256
19257So, to use this, simply say something like:
19258
19259@lisp
19260(setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
19261@end lisp
19262
19263
19264
19265@node Combined Groups
19266@section Combined Groups
19267
19268Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
19269groups.
19270
19271@menu
19272* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
19273* Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
19274@end menu
19275
19276
19277@node Virtual Groups
19278@subsection Virtual Groups
19279@cindex nnvirtual
19280@cindex virtual groups
19281@cindex merging groups
19282
19283An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
19284other groups.
19285
19286For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
19287put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
19288big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
19289
19290You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
19291regexp to match component groups.
19292
19293All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
19294component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
19295article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
19296came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
19297shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
19298@kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
19299and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
19300(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
19301
19302Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
19303newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
19304
19305@lisp
19306(nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
19307@end lisp
19308
19309The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
19310smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
19311
19312Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
19313idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
19314If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
19315and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
19316
19317@example
19318"^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
19319@end example
19320
19321(Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
19322shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
19323characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
19324
19325This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
19326end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
19327the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
19328sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
19329(@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
19330
19331One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
19332group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
19333zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
19334
19335@vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
19336If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
19337is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
19338articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
19339and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
19340been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
19341when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
19342have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
19343that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
19344just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
19345it---it'll have much the same effect.
19346
19347@code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
19348When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
19349has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
19350whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
19351there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
19352and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
19353not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
19354
19355@kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
19356line from the article you respond to in these cases.
19357
19358@code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
19359from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
19360inherited.
19361
19362
19363@node Kibozed Groups
19364@subsection Kibozed Groups
19365@cindex nnkiboze
19366@cindex kibozing
19367
19368@dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
19369(parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
19370do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
19371down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
19372
19373@kindex G k (Group)
19374To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
19375buffer.
19376
19377The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
19378@code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
19379@code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
19380@code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
19381
19382In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
19383@code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
19384to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
19385
19386@kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
19387@findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
19388You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
19389@code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
19390Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
19391headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
19392through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
19393the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
19394
19395Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
19396regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
19397@acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
19398Stranger things have happened.
19399
19400@code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
19401and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
19402
19403@vindex nnkiboze-directory
19404The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
19405@code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
19406One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
19407the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
19408information on what groups have been searched through to find
19409component articles.
19410
19411Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
19412their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
19413
19414
19415@node Email Based Diary
19416@section Email Based Diary
19417@cindex diary
19418@cindex email based diary
19419@cindex calendar
19420
19421This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
19422and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
19423sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
19424reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
19425Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
19426namely, as event reminders.
19427
19428Here is a typical scenario:
19429
19430@itemize @bullet
19431@item
19432You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
19433to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
19434@item
19435So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
19436@item
19437You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
19438@item
19439From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
19440is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
19441appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
19442@item
19443Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
19444of the night you're gonna have.
19445@item
19446Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
19447message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
19448@end itemize
19449
19450The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
19451(that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
19452real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
19453explained in the sections below.
19454
19455@menu
19456* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
19457* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
19458* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
19459@end menu
19460
19461
19462@node The NNDiary Back End
19463@subsection The NNDiary Back End
19464@cindex nndiary
19465@cindex the nndiary back end
19466
19467@code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
19468Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
19469@code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
19470the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
19471directory per group.
19472
19473 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
19474@code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
19475of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
19476Timestamp} to see how it's done.
19477
19478@menu
19479* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
19480* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
19481* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
19482@end menu
19483
19484@node Diary Messages
19485@subsubsection Diary Messages
19486@cindex nndiary messages
19487@cindex nndiary mails
19488
19489@code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
19490presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
19491@code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
19492@code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
19493@code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
19494@code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
19495crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
19496
19497@itemize @bullet
19498@item
19499For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
19500either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
19501(separated by a comma).
19502@item
19503A field is either an integer, or a range.
19504@item
19505A range is two integers separated by a dash.
19506@item
19507Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
19508@code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
19509for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
19510@item
19511As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
19512mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
19513that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
19514@item
19515The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
19516value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
19517values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
19518zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
19519list of available time zone values, see the variable
19520@code{nndiary-headers}.
19521@end itemize
19522
19523As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
19524for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
1952521:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
19526what to do then):
19527
19528@example
19529X-Diary-Minute: 0
19530X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
19531X-Diary-Dom: 1
19532X-Diary-Month: *
19533X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
19534X-Diary-Dow: 1
19535X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
19536@end example
19537
19538@node Running NNDiary
19539@subsubsection Running NNDiary
19540@cindex running nndiary
19541@cindex nndiary operation modes
19542
19543@code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
19544and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
19545mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
19546from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
19547as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
19548mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
19549
19550One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
19551``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
19552sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
19553messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
19554being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
19555the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
19556(which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
19557mode.
19558
19559In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
19560things to do:
19561
19562@itemize @bullet
19563@item
19564Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
19565line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
19566
19567@lisp
19568(setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
19569@end lisp
19570@item
19571You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
19572headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
19573Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
19574multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
19575source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
19576
19577As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
19578@file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
19579
19580@example
19581:0 HD :
19582* ^X-Diary
19583.nndiary
19584@end example
19585@end itemize
19586
19587Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
19588that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
19589
19590@defvar nndiary-mail-sources
19591This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
19592@code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
19593@code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
19594@end defvar
19595
19596@defvar nndiary-split-methods
19597This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
19598@code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
19599@end defvar
19600
19601 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
19602(something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
19603@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
19604
19605 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
19606@file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
19607autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
19608also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
19609diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
19610
19611@node Customizing NNDiary
19612@subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
19613@cindex customizing nndiary
19614@cindex nndiary customization
19615
19616Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
19617The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
19618browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
19619two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
19620
19621@defvar nndiary-reminders
19622This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
19623appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
19624before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
19625diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
19626mail.
19627@end defvar
19628
19629@defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
19630Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
19631default).
19632@end defvar
19633
19634
19635@node The Gnus Diary Library
19636@subsection The Gnus Diary Library
19637@cindex gnus-diary
19638@cindex the gnus diary library
19639
19640Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
19641so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
19642@code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
19643useful things for you.
19644
19645 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
19646
19647@lisp
19648(require 'gnus-diary)
19649@end lisp
19650
19651 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
19652(@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
19653(sorry if you used them before).
19654
19655
19656@menu
19657* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
19658* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
19659* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
19660* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
19661@end menu
19662
19663@node Diary Summary Line Format
19664@subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
19665@cindex diary summary buffer line
19666@cindex diary summary line format
19667
19668Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
19669something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
19670the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
19671see the event's date.
19672
19673 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
19674summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
19675for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
19676while @code{d} corresponds to an approximative remaining time until the
19677next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
19678
19679 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
19680@code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
19681expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
19682
19683@example
19684 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
19685@end example
19686
19687In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
19688following line to your diary groups'parameters:
19689
19690@lisp
19691(gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
19692@end lisp
19693
19694However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
19695Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
19696with the following user options:
19697
19698@defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
19699Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
19700Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
19701diary groups'parameters.
19702@end defvar
19703
19704@defvar gnus-diary-time-format
19705Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
19706used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
19707@end defvar
19708
19709@defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
19710Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
19711times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
19712format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
19713you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
19714@end defvar
19715
19716@node Diary Articles Sorting
19717@subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
19718@cindex diary articles sorting
19719@cindex diary summary lines sorting
19720@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
19721@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
19722@findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
19723
19724@code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
19725Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
19726@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
19727@code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
19728your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
19729
19730@code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
19731@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
19732buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
19733default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
19734Parameters}).
19735
19736@node Diary Headers Generation
19737@subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
19738@cindex diary headers generation
19739@findex gnus-diary-check-message
19740
19741@code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
19742@code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
19743headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
19744required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
19745needed.
19746
19747 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
19748moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
d55fe5bb
MB
19749automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
19750@code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
19751process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
4009494e
GM
19752
19753 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
19754all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
19755you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
19756instance.
19757
19758@node Diary Group Parameters
19759@subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
19760@cindex diary group parameters
19761
19762When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
19763automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
19764summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
19765diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
19766@code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
19767to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
19768on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
19769automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
19770
19771@node Sending or Not Sending
19772@subsection Sending or Not Sending
19773
19774Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
19775mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
19776
19777@itemize @bullet
19778@item
19779@code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
19780messsages for real. This means for instance that you can give
19781appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
19782sending the diary message to them as well.
19783@item
19784However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
19785can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
19786message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
19787comes in very handy for private appointments.
19788@end itemize
19789
19790@node Gnus Unplugged
19791@section Gnus Unplugged
19792@cindex offline
19793@cindex unplugged
19794@cindex agent
19795@cindex Gnus agent
19796@cindex Gnus unplugged
19797
19798In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
19799on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
19800was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
19801read news. Believe it or not.
19802
19803Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
19804modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
19805would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
19806the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
19807have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
19808
19809Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
19810@code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
19811for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
19812functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
19813reading news on a machine.
19814
19815Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
01c52d31
MB
19816fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
19817by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
4009494e
GM
19818
19819Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
19820
19821@menu
19822* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
19823* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
19824* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
19825* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
19826* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
19827* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
19828* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
01c52d31 19829* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
4009494e
GM
19830* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
19831* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
19832* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
19833* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
19834* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
19835* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
19836@end menu
19837
19838
19839@node Agent Basics
19840@subsection Agent Basics
19841
19842First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
19843
19844The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
19845connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
19846When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
19847Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
19848
19849The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
19850connected to the net continuously.
19851
19852@dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
19853machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
19854
19855You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
19856shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
19857is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
19858say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
19859you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
19860
19861Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
19862that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
19863can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
19864servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
19865they're kinda like plugged always).
19866
19867So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
19868connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
19869servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
19870the culprit.
19871
19872Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
19873reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
19874server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
19875server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
19876will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
19877
19878Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
19879
19880@itemize @bullet
19881
19882@item
19883@findex gnus-unplugged
19884You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
19885Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
19886already fetched while in this mode.
19887
19888@item
19889You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
19890your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
19891to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
19892as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
19893Source Specifiers}).
19894
19895@item
19896You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
19897news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
19898@kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
19899all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
19900articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
19901
19902@item
19903After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
19904unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
19905then you read the news offline.
19906
19907@item
19908And then you go to step 2.
19909@end itemize
19910
19911Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
19912the Agent.
19913
19914@itemize @bullet
19915
19916@item
19917Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
19918back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
19919Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
19920@kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
19921Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
19922added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
19923all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
19924@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
19925
19926@item
19927Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
19928you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
19929parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
19930is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
19931
19932Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
19933(@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
19934to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
19935parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
19936to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
19937your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
19938configure them.
19939
19940@item
19941Uhm@dots{} that's it.
19942@end itemize
19943
19944
19945@node Agent Categories
19946@subsection Agent Categories
19947
19948One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
19949newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
19950There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
19951find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
19952to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
19953mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
19954you're interested in the articles anyway.
19955
19956One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
19957downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
19958groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
19959category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
19960buffer for creating and managing categories.
19961
19962If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
19963Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
19964alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
19965difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
19966less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
19967sink.
19968
19969Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
19970a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
19971the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
19972parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
19973variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
19974of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
19975your settings.
19976
19977@menu
19978* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
19979* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
19980* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
19981@end menu
19982
19983
19984@node Category Syntax
19985@subsubsection Category Syntax
19986
19987A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
19988category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
19989customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
19990listed below.
19991
19992@cindex Agent Parameters
19993@table @code
01c52d31 19994@item agent-groups
4009494e
GM
19995The list of groups that are in this category.
19996
01c52d31 19997@item agent-predicate
4009494e
GM
19998A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
19999are eligible for downloading; and
20000
01c52d31 20001@item agent-score
4009494e
GM
20002a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
20003deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
20004score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
20005
01c52d31 20006@item agent-enable-expiration
4009494e
GM
20007a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
20008this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
20009fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
20010only groups that should not be expired.
20011
01c52d31 20012@item agent-days-until-old
4009494e
GM
20013an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
20014before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
20015
01c52d31 20016@item agent-low-score
4009494e
GM
20017an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
20018
01c52d31 20019@item agent-high-score
4009494e
GM
20020an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
20021
01c52d31 20022@item agent-short-article
4009494e
GM
20023an integer that overrides the value of
20024@code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
20025
01c52d31 20026@item agent-long-article
4009494e
GM
20027an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
20028
01c52d31 20029@item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
4009494e 20030a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
01c52d31
MB
20031undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
20032faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
20033undownloaded faces.
4009494e
GM
20034@end table
20035
20036The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
20037created.
20038
20039Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
20040that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
20041group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
20042category.
20043
20044A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
20045@code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
20046article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
20047predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
20048
20049Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
20050their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
20051@code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
20052
20053To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
20054download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
20055operators sprinkled in between.
20056
20057Perhaps some examples are in order.
20058
20059Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
20060for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
20061
20062@lisp
20063short
20064@end lisp
20065
20066Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
20067short (for some value of ``short'').
20068
20069Here's a more complex predicate:
20070
20071@lisp
20072(or high
20073 (and
20074 (not low)
20075 (not long)))
20076@end lisp
20077
20078This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
20079or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
20080drift.
20081
20082The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
20083@code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
20084@samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
20085
20086The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
20087you want to do, you can write your own.
20088
20089When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
20090bound to the value determined by calling
20091@code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
20092example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
20093@code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
20094means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
20095predicate to individual groups.
20096
20097@table @code
20098@item short
20099True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
20100lines; default 100.
20101
20102@item long
20103True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
20104lines; default 200.
20105
20106@item low
20107True if the article has a download score less than
20108@code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
20109
20110@item high
20111True if the article has a download score greater than
20112@code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
20113
20114@item spam
20115True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
20116heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
20117checksum and sees whether articles match.
20118
20119@item true
20120Always true.
20121
20122@item false
20123Always false.
20124@end table
20125
20126If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
20127to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
20128@code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
20129useful values.
20130
20131For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
20132that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
20133more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
20134something along the lines of the following:
20135
20136@lisp
20137(defun my-article-old-p ()
20138 "Say whether an article is old."
20139 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
20140 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
20141@end lisp
20142
20143with the predicate then defined as:
20144
20145@lisp
20146(not my-article-old-p)
20147@end lisp
20148
20149or you could append your predicate to the predefined
20150@code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
20151wherever.
20152
20153@lisp
20154(require 'gnus-agent)
20155(setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
20156 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
20157 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
20158@end lisp
20159
20160and simply specify your predicate as:
20161
20162@lisp
20163(not old)
20164@end lisp
20165
20166If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
20167misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
20168always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
20169just don't give a damn.
20170
20171The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
20172category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
20173individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
20174new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
20175parameters like so:
20176
20177@lisp
20178(agent-predicate . short)
20179@end lisp
20180
20181This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
20182Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
20183@code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
20184
20185The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
20186
20187@lisp
20188(agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
20189@end lisp
20190
20191The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
20192entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
20193predicate is assumed to be a list.
20194
20195
20196Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
20197normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
20198seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
20199following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
20200@code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
20201@code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
20202
20203As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
20204to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
20205it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
20206if it's to be specific to that group.
20207
20208In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
20209three forms:
20210
20211@enumerate
20212@item
20213Score rule
20214
20215This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
20216subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
20217
20218example:
20219
20220@itemize @bullet
20221@item
20222Category specification
20223
20224@lisp
20225(("from"
20226 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
20227("lines"
20228 (500 -100 nil <)))
20229@end lisp
20230
20231@item
20232Group/Topic Parameter specification
20233
20234@lisp
20235(agent-score ("from"
20236 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
20237 ("lines"
20238 (500 -100 nil <)))
20239@end lisp
20240
20241Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
20242@end itemize
20243
20244@item
20245Agent score file
20246
20247These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
20248keywords stated above.
20249
20250example:
20251
20252@itemize @bullet
20253@item
20254Category specification
20255
20256@lisp
20257("~/News/agent.SCORE")
20258@end lisp
20259
20260or perhaps
20261
20262@lisp
20263("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
20264@end lisp
20265
20266@item
20267Group Parameter specification
20268
20269@lisp
20270(agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
20271@end lisp
20272
20273Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
20274about parenthesis?
20275@end itemize
20276
20277@item
20278Use @code{normal} score files
20279
20280If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
20281your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
20282@code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
20283@code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
20284
20285These directives in either the category definition or a group's
20286parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
20287files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
20288relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
20289
20290@itemize @bullet
20291@item
20292Category Specification
20293
20294@lisp
20295file
20296@end lisp
20297
20298@item
20299Group Parameter specification
20300
20301@lisp
20302(agent-score . file)
20303@end lisp
20304@end itemize
20305@end enumerate
20306
20307@node Category Buffer
20308@subsubsection Category Buffer
20309
20310You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
20311When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
20312the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
20313
20314The following commands are available in this buffer:
20315
20316@table @kbd
20317@item q
20318@kindex q (Category)
20319@findex gnus-category-exit
20320Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
20321
20322@item e
20323@kindex e (Category)
20324@findex gnus-category-customize-category
20325Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
20326parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
20327
20328@item k
20329@kindex k (Category)
20330@findex gnus-category-kill
20331Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
20332
20333@item c
20334@kindex c (Category)
20335@findex gnus-category-copy
20336Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
20337
20338@item a
20339@kindex a (Category)
20340@findex gnus-category-add
20341Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
20342
20343@item p
20344@kindex p (Category)
20345@findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
20346Edit the predicate of the current category
20347(@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
20348
20349@item g
20350@kindex g (Category)
20351@findex gnus-category-edit-groups
20352Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
20353(@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
20354
20355@item s
20356@kindex s (Category)
20357@findex gnus-category-edit-score
20358Edit the download score rule of the current category
20359(@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
20360
20361@item l
20362@kindex l (Category)
20363@findex gnus-category-list
20364List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
20365@end table
20366
20367
20368@node Category Variables
20369@subsubsection Category Variables
20370
20371@table @code
20372@item gnus-category-mode-hook
20373@vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
20374Hook run in category buffers.
20375
20376@item gnus-category-line-format
20377@vindex gnus-category-line-format
20378Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
20379Variables}). Valid elements are:
20380
20381@table @samp
20382@item c
20383The name of the category.
20384
20385@item g
20386The number of groups in the category.
20387@end table
20388
20389@item gnus-category-mode-line-format
20390@vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
20391Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
20392
20393@item gnus-agent-short-article
20394@vindex gnus-agent-short-article
20395Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
20396
20397@item gnus-agent-long-article
20398@vindex gnus-agent-long-article
20399Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
20400
20401@item gnus-agent-low-score
20402@vindex gnus-agent-low-score
20403Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
204040.
20405
20406@item gnus-agent-high-score
20407@vindex gnus-agent-high-score
20408Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
204090.
20410
20411@item gnus-agent-expire-days
20412@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
20413The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
20414local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
20415the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
20416just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
20417important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
20418article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
20419read.
20420Default 7.
20421
20422@item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
20423@vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
20424Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
20425retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
20426you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
20427you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
20428have to enable expiration in selected groups.
20429
20430@end table
20431
20432
20433@node Agent Commands
20434@subsection Agent Commands
20435@findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
20436@kindex J j (Agent)
20437
20438All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
20439(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
20440toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
20441
20442
20443@menu
20444* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
20445* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
20446* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
20447@end menu
20448
20449
20450
20451
20452@node Group Agent Commands
20453@subsubsection Group Agent Commands
20454
20455@table @kbd
20456@item J u
20457@kindex J u (Agent Group)
20458@findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
20459Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
20460(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
20461
20462@item J c
20463@kindex J c (Agent Group)
20464@findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
20465Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
20466
20467@item J s
20468@kindex J s (Agent Group)
20469@findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
20470Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
20471(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
20472
20473@item J S
20474@kindex J S (Agent Group)
20475@findex gnus-group-send-queue
20476Send all sendable messages in the queue group
20477(@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
20478
20479@item J a
20480@kindex J a (Agent Group)
20481@findex gnus-agent-add-group
20482Add the current group to an Agent category
20483(@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
20484process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
20485
20486@item J r
20487@kindex J r (Agent Group)
20488@findex gnus-agent-remove-group
20489Remove the current group from its category, if any
20490(@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
20491process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
20492
20493@item J Y
20494@kindex J Y (Agent Group)
20495@findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20496Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
20497
20498
20499@end table
20500
20501
20502@node Summary Agent Commands
20503@subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
20504
20505@table @kbd
20506@item J #
20507@kindex J # (Agent Summary)
20508@findex gnus-agent-mark-article
20509Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
20510
20511@item J M-#
20512@kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
20513@findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
20514Remove the downloading mark from the article
20515(@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
20516
20517@cindex %
20518@item @@
20519@kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
20520@findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
20521Toggle whether to download the article
20522(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
20523default.
20524
20525@item J c
20526@kindex J c (Agent Summary)
20527@findex gnus-agent-catchup
20528Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
20529
20530@item J S
20531@kindex J S (Agent Summary)
20532@findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
20533Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
20534(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
20535
20536@item J s
20537@kindex J s (Agent Summary)
01c52d31 20538@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
4009494e 20539Download all processable articles in this group.
01c52d31 20540(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
4009494e
GM
20541
20542@item J u
20543@kindex J u (Agent Summary)
20544@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
20545Download all downloadable articles in the current group
20546(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
20547
20548@end table
20549
20550
20551@node Server Agent Commands
20552@subsubsection Server Agent Commands
20553
20554@table @kbd
20555@item J a
20556@kindex J a (Agent Server)
20557@findex gnus-agent-add-server
20558Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
20559(@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
20560
20561@item J r
20562@kindex J r (Agent Server)
20563@findex gnus-agent-remove-server
20564Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
20565Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
20566
20567@end table
20568
20569
20570@node Agent Visuals
20571@subsection Agent Visuals
20572
20573If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
20574active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
20575stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
20576something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
20577placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
20578there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
20579When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
20580placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
20581You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
20582placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
20583
20584While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
20585available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
20586fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
20587way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
20588less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
20589adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
20590the download status of each article so that you always know which
20591articles will be available when unplugged.
20592
20593The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
20594@code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
20595a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
20596Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
20597will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
20598other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
20599@samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
20600(@samp{ }) will be displayed.
20601
20602The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
20603are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
20604result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
20605that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
20606face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
20607tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
20608conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
20609that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
20610to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
20611
20612If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
20613each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
20614undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
20615being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
01c52d31
MB
20616downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
20617users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
20618database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
20619to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
20620of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
20621normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
20622
20623If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
20624undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
20625group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
20626parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
20627a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
20628(@pxref{Group Parameters}).
20629
20630The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
20631can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
20632even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
20633is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
20634This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
20635fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
20636the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
20637expiring'' articles.
4009494e
GM
20638
20639@node Agent as Cache
20640@subsection Agent as Cache
20641
20642When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
20643articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
20644Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
20645in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
20646buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
20647are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
20648consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
20649article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
20650server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
20651
20652If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
20653@pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
20654plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
20655synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
20656sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
20657
20658@node Agent Expiry
20659@subsection Agent Expiry
20660
20661@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
20662@findex gnus-agent-expire
20663@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
20664@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
20665@findex gnus-agent-expire-group
20666@cindex agent expiry
20667@cindex Gnus agent expiry
20668@cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
20669
20670The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
20671least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
20672special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
20673commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
20674@code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
20675that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
20676efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
20677@kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
20678
20679Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
20680might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
20681synchronized with the group.
20682
20683The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
20684prevent expiration in selected groups.
20685
20686@vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
20687If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
20688expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
20689and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
20690are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
20691be kept indefinitely.
20692
20693If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
20694perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
20695commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
20696@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
20697
20698@node Agent Regeneration
20699@subsection Agent Regeneration
20700
20701@cindex agent regeneration
20702@cindex Gnus agent regeneration
20703@cindex regeneration
20704
20705The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
20706due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
20707@code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
20708to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
20709internal inconsistencies.
20710
20711For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
20712downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
20713know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
20714failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
20715@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
20716such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
20717
20718@findex gnus-agent-regenerate
20719@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
20720The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
20721@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
20722you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
20723recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
20724
20725@findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
20726@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
20727The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
20728of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
20729then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
20730are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
20731agent as unread.
20732
01c52d31
MB
20733@node Agent and flags
20734@subsection Agent and flags
4009494e 20735
01c52d31
MB
20736The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
20737nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
20738the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
20739the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
20740Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
20741to the flags in its own files.
4009494e 20742
01c52d31
MB
20743When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
20744changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
20745server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
4009494e
GM
20746
20747@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20748If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
20749never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
20750the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
20751ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
20752any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
20753
20754If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
20755re-connect, you can do it manually with the
20756@code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
20757in the group buffer.
20758
01c52d31
MB
20759Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
20760all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
20761server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
20762the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
20763re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
20764removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
20765operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
20766directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
20767
20768@node Agent and IMAP
20769@subsection Agent and IMAP
20770
20771The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
20772since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
20773@acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
20774make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
20775
4009494e
GM
20776Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
20777expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
20778
20779@itemize @bullet
20780
20781@item
20782Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
20783
20784@item
20785Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
20786
20787@end itemize
20788
4009494e
GM
20789@node Outgoing Messages
20790@subsection Outgoing Messages
20791
01c52d31
MB
20792By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
20793and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
20794You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
4009494e 20795
01c52d31
MB
20796You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
20797(see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
20798news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
4009494e 20799
01c52d31
MB
20800You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
20801commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
20802group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
20803Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
20804mail at any time.
4009494e 20805
01c52d31
MB
20806If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
20807about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
20808ask you to confirm your action (see
20809@code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
4009494e
GM
20810
20811@node Agent Variables
20812@subsection Agent Variables
20813
20814@table @code
01c52d31
MB
20815@item gnus-agent
20816@vindex gnus-agent
20817Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
20818the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
20819automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
20820back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
20821
20822To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
20823(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
20824
20825
4009494e
GM
20826@item gnus-agent-directory
20827@vindex gnus-agent-directory
20828Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
20829@file{~/News/agent/}.
20830
20831@item gnus-agent-handle-level
20832@vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
20833Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
20834be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
20835which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
20836by default.
20837
20838@item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
20839@vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
20840Hook run when connecting to the network.
20841
20842@item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
20843@vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
20844Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
20845
20846@item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
20847@vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
20848Hook run when finished fetching articles.
20849
20850@item gnus-agent-cache
20851@vindex gnus-agent-cache
20852Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
20853articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
20854The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
20855
20856@item gnus-agent-go-online
20857@vindex gnus-agent-go-online
20858If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
20859automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
20860@code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
20861offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
20862other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
20863online status.
20864
20865@item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
20866@vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
20867If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
20868mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
20869thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
20870read. The default is @code{t}.
20871
01c52d31
MB
20872@item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20873@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20874If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
20875never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
20876the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
20877ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
20878any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
20879
4009494e
GM
20880@item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
20881@vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
20882If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
20883agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
20884downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
20885the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
20886are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
20887into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
20888the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
20889over and over again.
20890
20891@item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
20892@vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
20893The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
20894them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
20895the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
20896have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
20897limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
20898performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
20899connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
20900@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
20901However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
20902available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
20903see any cycling.
20904
20905@item gnus-server-unopen-status
20906@vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
20907Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
20908variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
20909Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
20910whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
20911Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
20912for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
20913is only valid if the Agent is used.
20914
20915@item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
20916@vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
20917Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
20918that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
20919buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
20920agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
20921
20922The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
20923@code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
20924have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
20925ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
20926(maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
20927
01c52d31
MB
20928@item gnus-agent-queue-mail
20929@vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
20930When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
20931queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
20932will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
20933mail. The default is @code{t}.
20934
20935@item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
20936@vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
20937When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
20938prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
20939@kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
20940
4009494e
GM
20941@item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
20942@vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
20943If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
20944@file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
20945automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
01c52d31
MB
20946which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
20947to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
4009494e
GM
20948as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
20949If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
20950removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
20951start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
20952
20953@end table
20954
20955
20956@node Example Setup
20957@subsection Example Setup
20958
20959If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
20960setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
20961@file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
20962
20963@lisp
20964;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
20965;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
20966(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
20967
20968;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
20969;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
20970(setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
20971
20972;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
20973(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
20974
20975;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
20976;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
20977;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
20978@end lisp
20979
20980That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
20981edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
20982gnus}.
20983
20984If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
20985automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
20986subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
20987@acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
20988command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
20989once.
20990
20991After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
20992groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
20993command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
20994subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
20995back all the killed groups.)
20996
20997You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
20998with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
20999find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
21000
21001
21002@node Batching Agents
21003@subsection Batching Agents
21004@findex gnus-agent-batch
21005
21006Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
21007written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
21008following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
21009
21010You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
21011following incantation:
21012
21013@example
21014#!/bin/sh
21015emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
21016@end example
21017
21018
21019@node Agent Caveats
21020@subsection Agent Caveats
21021
21022The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
21023newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
21024may ask:
21025
21026@table @dfn
21027@item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
21028
21029@strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
21030@code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
21031@code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
21032
21033@item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
21034the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
21035
21036@strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
21037
21038@end table
21039
21040In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
21041articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
21042locally stored articles.
21043
21044
21045@node Scoring
21046@chapter Scoring
21047@cindex scoring
21048
21049Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
21050scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
21051something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
21052attention!
21053
21054@vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
21055All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
21056which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
21057interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
21058@code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
21059
21060Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
21061before generating the summary buffer.
21062
21063There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
21064entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
21065lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
21066
21067There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
21068Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
21069temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
21070silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
21071
21072@menu
21073* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
21074* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
21075* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
21076* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
21077* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
21078* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
21079* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
21080* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
21081* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
21082* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
21083* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
21084* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
21085* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
21086* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
4009494e
GM
21087* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
21088* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
21089@end menu
21090
21091
21092@node Summary Score Commands
21093@section Summary Score Commands
21094@cindex score commands
21095
21096The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
21097score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
21098previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
21099@dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
21100entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
21101
21102The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
21103if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
21104some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
21105score file the current one.
21106
21107General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
21108
21109@table @kbd
21110
21111@item V s
21112@kindex V s (Summary)
21113@findex gnus-summary-set-score
21114Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
21115
21116@item V S
21117@kindex V S (Summary)
21118@findex gnus-summary-current-score
21119Display the score of the current article
21120(@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
21121
21122@item V t
21123@kindex V t (Summary)
21124@findex gnus-score-find-trace
21125Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
21126(@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
21127may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
21128current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
21129score file and edit it.
21130
21131@item V w
21132@kindex V w (Summary)
21133@findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
21134List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
21135
21136@item V R
21137@kindex V R (Summary)
21138@findex gnus-summary-rescore
21139Run the current summary through the scoring process
21140(@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
21141around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
21142effect you're having.
21143
21144@item V c
21145@kindex V c (Summary)
21146@findex gnus-score-change-score-file
21147Make a different score file the current
21148(@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
21149
21150@item V e
21151@kindex V e (Summary)
21152@findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
21153Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
21154You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
21155File Editing}).
21156
21157@item V f
21158@kindex V f (Summary)
21159@findex gnus-score-edit-file
21160Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
21161(@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
21162
21163@item V F
21164@kindex V F (Summary)
21165@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
21166Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
21167after editing score files.
21168
21169@item V C
21170@kindex V C (Summary)
21171@findex gnus-score-customize
21172Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
21173(@code{gnus-score-customize}).
21174
21175@end table
21176
21177The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
21178
21179@table @kbd
21180
21181@item V m
21182@kindex V m (Summary)
21183@findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
21184Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
21185read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
21186
21187@item V x
21188@kindex V x (Summary)
21189@findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
21190Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
21191expunge all articles below this score
21192(@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
21193@end table
21194
21195The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
21196pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
21197them.)
21198
21199@findex gnus-summary-increase-score
21200@findex gnus-summary-lower-score
21201
21202@enumerate
21203@item
21204The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
21205or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
21206@item
21207The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
21208keys are available:
21209@table @kbd
21210
21211@item a
21212Score on the author name.
21213
21214@item s
21215Score on the subject line.
21216
21217@item x
21218Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
21219
21220@item r
21221Score on the @code{References} line.
21222
21223@item d
21224Score on the date.
21225
21226@item l
21227Score on the number of lines.
21228
21229@item i
21230Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
21231
21232@item e
21233Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
21234if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
21235
21236@item f
21237Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
21238the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
21239@file{ADAPT} files.)
21240
21241@item b
21242Score on the body.
21243
21244@item h
21245Score on the head.
21246
21247@item t
21248Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
21249files.)
21250
21251@end table
21252
21253@item
21254The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
21255what headers you are scoring on.
21256
21257@table @code
21258
21259@item strings
21260
21261@table @kbd
21262
21263@item e
21264Exact matching.
21265
21266@item s
21267Substring matching.
21268
21269@item f
21270Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
21271
21272@item r
21273Regexp matching
21274@end table
21275
21276@item date
21277@table @kbd
21278
21279@item b
21280Before date.
21281
21282@item a
21283After date.
21284
21285@item n
21286This date.
21287@end table
21288
21289@item number
21290@table @kbd
21291
21292@item <
21293Less than number.
21294
21295@item =
21296Equal to number.
21297
21298@item >
21299Greater than number.
21300@end table
21301@end table
21302
21303@item
21304The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
21305expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
21306or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
21307file.
21308@table @kbd
21309
21310@item t
21311Temporary score entry.
21312
21313@item p
21314Permanent score entry.
21315
21316@item i
21317Immediately scoring.
21318@end table
21319
21320@item
21321If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
21322the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
21323in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
21324
21325@end enumerate
21326
21327So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
21328exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
21329score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
21330temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
21331
21332To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
21333a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
21334defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
21335``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
21336t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
21337
21338These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
21339(@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
21340(or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
21341says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
21342current score file.
21343
21344@vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
21345The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
21346pretend they are keymaps or not.
21347
21348
21349@node Group Score Commands
21350@section Group Score Commands
21351@cindex group score commands
21352
21353There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
21354
21355@table @kbd
21356
01c52d31
MB
21357@item W e
21358@kindex W e (Group)
21359@findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
21360Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
21361a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
21362
4009494e
GM
21363@item W f
21364@kindex W f (Group)
21365@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
21366Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
21367all the time. This command will flush the cache
21368(@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
21369
21370@end table
21371
21372You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
21373
21374@findex gnus-batch-score
21375@cindex batch scoring
21376@example
21377$ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
21378@end example
21379
21380
21381@node Score Variables
21382@section Score Variables
21383@cindex score variables
21384
21385@table @code
21386
21387@item gnus-use-scoring
21388@vindex gnus-use-scoring
21389If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
21390general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
21391
21392@item gnus-kill-killed
21393@vindex gnus-kill-killed
21394If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
21395articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
21396may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
21397to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
21398group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
21399variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
21400
21401@item gnus-kill-files-directory
21402@vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
21403All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
21404initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
21405This is @file{~/News/} by default.
21406
21407@item gnus-score-file-suffix
21408@vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
21409Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
21410(@file{SCORE} by default.)
21411
21412@item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
21413@vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
21414@cindex score cache
21415All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
bbbe940b 21416score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
4009494e
GM
21417bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
21418to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
21419@file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
21420@file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
21421variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
21422be cached.
21423
21424@item gnus-save-score
21425@vindex gnus-save-score
21426If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
21427scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
21428Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
21429
21430If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
21431with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
21432across group visits.
21433
21434@item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
21435@vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
21436Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
21437score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
21438ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
21439We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
21440manually entered data.
21441
21442@item gnus-summary-default-score
21443@vindex gnus-summary-default-score
21444Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
21445
21446@item gnus-summary-expunge-below
21447@vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
21448Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
21449this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
21450articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
21451and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
21452
21453@item gnus-score-over-mark
21454@vindex gnus-score-over-mark
21455Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
21456default. Default is @samp{+}.
21457
21458@item gnus-score-below-mark
21459@vindex gnus-score-below-mark
21460Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
21461default. Default is @samp{-}.
21462
21463@item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
21464@vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
21465Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
21466is called with the name of the group as the argument.
21467
21468Predefined functions available are:
21469@table @code
21470
21471@item gnus-score-find-single
21472@findex gnus-score-find-single
21473Only apply the group's own score file.
21474
21475@item gnus-score-find-bnews
21476@findex gnus-score-find-bnews
21477Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
21478default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
21479@file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
21480@file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
21481@samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
21482then a regexp match is done.
21483
21484This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
21485all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
21486
21487The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
21488try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
21489files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
21490file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
21491
21492@item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
21493@findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
21494Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
21495can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
21496@file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
21497server.
21498
21499@end table
21500This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
21501these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
21502all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
21503functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
21504that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
21505should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
21506ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
21507Phu.
21508
21509For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
21510overall score file, you could use the value
21511@example
21512(list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
21513 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
21514@end example
21515
21516@item gnus-score-expiry-days
21517@vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
21518This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
21519entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
21520are expired. It's 7 by default.
21521
21522@item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
21523@vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
21524If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
21525been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
21526controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
21527matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
21528variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
21529have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
21530
21531@item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
21532@vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
21533Function called with the name of the score file just written.
21534
21535@item gnus-score-thread-simplify
21536@vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
21537If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
21538simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
21539threading---according to the current value of
21540@code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
21541@code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
21542simplified in this manner.
21543
21544@end table
21545
21546
21547@node Score File Format
21548@section Score File Format
21549@cindex score file format
21550
21551A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
21552single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
21553everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
21554
21555Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
21556
21557@lisp
21558(("from"
21559 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
21560 ("Per Abrahamsen")
21561 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
21562 ("subject"
21563 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
21564 ("xref"
21565 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
21566 ("lines"
21567 (2 -100 nil <))
21568 (mark 0)
21569 (expunge -1000)
21570 (mark-and-expunge -10)
21571 (read-only nil)
21572 (orphan -10)
21573 (adapt t)
21574 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
21575 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
21576 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
21577 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
21578 (eval (ding)))
21579@end lisp
21580
21581This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
21582Scoring}, for a different approach.
21583
21584Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
21585@code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
21586has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
21587
21588Six keys are supported by this alist:
21589
21590@table @code
21591
21592@item STRING
21593If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
21594match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
21595@code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
21596@code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
21597these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
21598article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
21599will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
21600perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
21601perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
21602last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
21603final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
21604entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
21605to articles that matches these score entries.
21606
21607Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
21608score entry has one to four elements.
21609@enumerate
21610
21611@item
21612The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
21613be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
21614integer.
21615
21616@item
21617If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
21618element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
21619interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
21620is successful. If this element is not present, the
21621@code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
21622instead. This is 1000 by default.
21623
21624@item
21625If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
21626element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
21627which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
21628element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
21629represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
21630
21631@item
21632If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
21633element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
21634whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
21635be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
21636@table @dfn
21637
21638@item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
21639For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
21640well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
21641@code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
21642element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
21643be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
21644that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
21645one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
21646@code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
21647instead, if you feel like.
21648
21649@item Extra
21650Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
21651gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
21652case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
21653header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
21654@file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
21655host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
21656overviews:
21657
21658@lisp
21659("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
21660 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
21661@end lisp
21662
21663@item Lines, Chars
21664These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
21665@code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
21666
21667These predicates are true if
21668
21669@example
21670(PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
21671@end example
21672
21673evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
21674@code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
21675following form:
21676
21677@lisp
21678(< header-value 4)
21679@end lisp
21680
21681Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
21682the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
21683(It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
21684it's not. I think.)
21685
21686When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
21687@code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
21688up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
21689you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
21690
21691@item Date
21692For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
21693@code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
21694ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
21695this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
21696Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
21697sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
21698quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
21699
21700@cindex ISO8601
21701@cindex date
21702A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
21703date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
21704ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
21705you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
21706every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
21707for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
21708this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
21709the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
21710whole family, eh?)
21711
21712@item Head, Body, All
21713These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
21714header uses.
21715
21716@item Followup
21717This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
21718@code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
21719articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
21720you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
21721decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
21722trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
21723uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
21724files.)
21725
21726@item Thread
21727This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
21728key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
21729article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
21730match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
21731has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
21732matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
21733This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
21734even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
21735@code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
21736undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
21737key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
21738@end table
21739@end enumerate
21740
21741@cindex score file atoms
21742@item mark
21743The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21744lower than this number will be marked as read.
21745
21746@item expunge
21747The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21748lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
21749
21750@item mark-and-expunge
21751The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21752lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
21753summary buffer.
21754
21755@item thread-mark-and-expunge
21756The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
21757a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
21758and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
21759says how to compute the total score for a thread.
21760
21761@item files
21762The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
21763are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
21764this one was.
21765
21766@item exclude-files
21767The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
21768not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
21769other.
21770
21771@item eval
21772The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
21773ignored when handling global score files.
21774
21775@item read-only
21776Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
21777should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
21778@dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
21779apply-to-all-groups score files.)
21780
21781@item orphan
21782The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
21783parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
21784some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
21785will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
21786
21787You can do this with the following two score file entries:
21788
21789@example
21790 (orphan -500)
21791 (mark-and-expunge -100)
21792@end example
21793
21794When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
21795threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
21796interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
21797rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
21798interesting threads, plus any new threads.
21799
21800I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
21801interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
21802scoring rules exist.
21803
21804@item adapt
21805This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
21806default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
21807adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
21808list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
21809or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
21810adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
21811scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
21812@code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
21813not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
21814groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
21815insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
21816it.
21817
21818@item adapt-file
21819All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
21820will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
21821if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
21822file for a number of groups.
21823
21824@item local
21825@cindex local variables
21826The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
21827@var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
21828current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
21829convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
21830groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
21831be evaluated.
21832@end table
21833
21834
21835@node Score File Editing
21836@section Score File Editing
21837
21838You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
21839might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
21840with a mode for that.
21841
21842It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
21843additional commands:
21844
21845@table @kbd
21846
21847@item C-c C-c
21848@kindex C-c C-c (Score)
87035689 21849@findex gnus-score-edit-exit
4009494e 21850Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
87035689 21851(@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
4009494e
GM
21852
21853@item C-c C-d
21854@kindex C-c C-d (Score)
21855@findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
21856Insert the current date in numerical format
21857(@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
21858you were wondering.
21859
21860@item C-c C-p
21861@kindex C-c C-p (Score)
21862@findex gnus-score-pretty-print
21863The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
21864intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
21865first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
21866you.
21867
21868@end table
21869
21870Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
21871
21872@vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
21873@code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
21874
21875In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
21876@kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
21877
21878
21879@node Adaptive Scoring
21880@section Adaptive Scoring
21881@cindex adaptive scoring
21882
21883If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
21884happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
21885stupidity, to be precise.
21886
21887@vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
21888When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
21889article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
21890these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
21891You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
21892@code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
21893words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
21894@code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
21895variable to @code{(word line)}.
21896
21897@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
21898To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
21899the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
21900might look something like this:
21901
21902@lisp
21903(setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
21904 '((gnus-unread-mark)
21905 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
21906 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
21907 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
21908 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
21909 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
21910 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
21911 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
21912 (gnus-ancient-mark)
21913 (gnus-low-score-mark)
21914 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
21915@end lisp
21916
21917As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
21918variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
21919a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
21920pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
21921that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
21922@code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
21923entries.
21924
21925Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
21926will be applied to each article.
21927
21928To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
21929articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
21930score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
21931lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
21932
21933If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
21934@code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
21935That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
21936should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
21937
21938If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
21939the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
21940probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
21941adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
21942
21943The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
21944@code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
21945@code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
21946@code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
21947on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
21948current article, thereby matching the following thread.
21949
21950If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
21951to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
21952changes result in articles getting marked as read.
21953
21954After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
21955become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
21956the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
21957
21958You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
21959by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
21960let you use different rules in different groups.
21961
21962@vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
21963The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
21964group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
21965is @file{ADAPT}.
21966
01c52d31
MB
21967@vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
21968Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
21969human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
21970deafult) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
21971
4009494e
GM
21972@vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
21973When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
21974give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
21975matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
21976the length of the match is less than
21977@code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
21978this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
21979this problem.
21980
21981@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
21982As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
21983headers. If you adapt on words, the
21984@code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
21985each instance of a word should add given a mark.
21986
21987@lisp
21988(setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
21989 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
21990 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
21991 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
21992 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
21993@end lisp
21994
21995This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
21996word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
21997@code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
21998score with 30 points.
21999
22000@vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
22001@vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
22002Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
22003will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
22004@code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
22005
22006@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
22007Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
22008scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
22009an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
22010variable defaults to @code{nil}.
22011
22012@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
22013When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
22014syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
22015it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
22016
22017@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
22018If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
22019word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
22020below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
22021
22022@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
22023If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
22024won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
22025for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
22026lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
22027
22028After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
22029@code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
22030what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
22031
22032Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
22033likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
22034that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
22035rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
22036
22037
22038@node Home Score File
22039@section Home Score File
22040
22041The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
22042@dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
22043for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
22044@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
22045
22046However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
22047a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
22048could perhaps use the same home score file.
22049
22050@vindex gnus-home-score-file
22051The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
22052be:
22053
22054@enumerate
22055@item
22056A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
22057groups.
22058
22059@item
22060A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
22061file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
22062parameter.
22063
22064@item
22065A list. The elements in this list can be:
22066
22067@enumerate
22068@item
22069@code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
22070group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
22071
22072@item
22073A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
22074be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
22075name of the group as the parameter.
22076
22077@item
22078A string. Use the string as the home score file.
22079@end enumerate
22080
22081The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
22082for matches.
22083
22084@end enumerate
22085
22086So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
22087
22088@lisp
22089(setq gnus-home-score-file
22090 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
22091@end lisp
22092
22093If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
22094@file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
22095
22096@findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
22097@lisp
22098(setq gnus-home-score-file
22099 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
22100@end lisp
22101
22102This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
22103Other functions include
22104
22105@table @code
22106@item gnus-current-home-score-file
22107@findex gnus-current-home-score-file
22108Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
22109commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
22110
22111@end table
22112
22113If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
22114another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
22115their own home score files:
22116
22117@lisp
22118(setq gnus-home-score-file
22119 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
22120 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
22121 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
22122 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
22123@end lisp
22124
22125@vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
22126@code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
22127@code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
22128is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
22129specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
22130
22131In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
22132@code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
22133(@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
22134Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
22135precedence over this variable.
22136
22137
22138@node Followups To Yourself
22139@section Followups To Yourself
22140
22141Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
22142the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
22143this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
22144articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
22145respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
22146to easily note when people answer what you've said.
22147
22148@table @code
22149
22150@item gnus-score-followup-article
22151@findex gnus-score-followup-article
22152This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
22153article.
22154
22155@item gnus-score-followup-thread
22156@findex gnus-score-followup-thread
22157This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
22158your own article.
22159@end table
22160
22161@vindex message-sent-hook
22162These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
22163@code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
22164@lisp
22165(add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
22166@end lisp
22167
22168
22169If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
22170the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
22171mine:
22172
22173@example
22174<x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
22175<x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
22176@end example
22177
22178So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
22179exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
22180myself:
22181
22182@lisp
22183("references"
22184 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
22185 1000 nil r))
22186@end lisp
22187
22188Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
22189is system-dependent.
22190
22191
22192@node Scoring On Other Headers
22193@section Scoring On Other Headers
22194@cindex scoring on other headers
22195
22196Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
22197headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
22198other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
22199that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
22200matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
22201
58333467
MB
22202@vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
22203You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
22204variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
22205@code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
22206the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
22207inhibited for all groups.
22208
22209Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
4009494e
GM
22210mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
22211it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
22212a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
22213@samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
22214
22215Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22216
22217@lisp
22218(setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
22219 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
22220@end lisp
22221
22222Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
22223@kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
22224time if you have much mail.
22225
22226Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
22227so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
22228
22229See? Simple.
22230
22231
22232@node Scoring Tips
22233@section Scoring Tips
22234@cindex scoring tips
22235
22236@table @dfn
22237
22238@item Crossposts
22239@cindex crossposts
22240@cindex scoring crossposts
22241If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
22242the @code{Xref} header.
22243@lisp
22244("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
22245@end lisp
22246
22247@item Multiple crossposts
22248If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
22249more than, say, 3 groups:
22250@lisp
22251("xref"
22252 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
22253 -1000 nil r))
22254@end lisp
22255
22256@item Matching on the body
22257This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
22258Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
22259you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
22260keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
22261and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
22262will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
22263@code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
22264the matches.
22265
22266@item Marking as read
22267You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
22268number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
22269in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
22270@lisp
22271((mark -100))
22272@end lisp
22273You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
22274
22275@item Negated character classes
22276If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
22277That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
22278@code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
22279@end table
22280
22281
22282@node Reverse Scoring
22283@section Reverse Scoring
22284@cindex reverse scoring
22285
22286If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
22287subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
22288like this in your score file:
22289
22290@lisp
22291(("subject"
22292 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
22293 (mark 1)
22294 (expunge 1))
22295@end lisp
22296
22297So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
22298rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
22299
22300
22301@node Global Score Files
22302@section Global Score Files
22303@cindex global score files
22304
22305Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
22306nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
22307in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
22308
22309What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
22310all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
22311big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
22312
22313@vindex gnus-global-score-files
22314All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
22315@code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
22316or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
22317files are applicable to which group.
22318
22319To use the score file
22320@file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
22321all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
22322say this:
22323
22324@lisp
22325(setq gnus-global-score-files
22326 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
22327 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
22328@end lisp
22329
22330@findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
22331@noindent
22332Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
22333directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
22334If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
22335use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
22336
22337Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
22338somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
22339
22340If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
22341just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
22342world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
22343wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
22344sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
22345premises! Yay! The net is saved!
22346
22347Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
22348head:
22349
22350@itemize @bullet
22351
22352@item
22353Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
22354@item
22355To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
22356@item
22357Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
22358@item
22359Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
22360lowered out of existence.
22361@item
22362Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
22363articles completely.
22364
22365@item
22366Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
22367should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
22368old articles for a long time.
22369@end itemize
22370
22371@dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
22372in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
22373Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
22374holding our breath yet?
22375
22376
22377@node Kill Files
22378@section Kill Files
22379@cindex kill files
22380
22381Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
22382entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
22383Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
22384
22385In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
22386than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
22387files into score files.
22388
22389Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
22390forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
22391sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
22392that isn't a very good idea.
22393
22394Normal kill files look like this:
22395
22396@lisp
22397(gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
22398(gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
22399(gnus-expunge "X")
22400@end lisp
22401
22402This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
22403marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
22404
22405Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
22406encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
22407interpreting it.
22408
22409Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
22410
22411@table @kbd
22412
22413@item M-k
22414@kindex M-k (Summary)
22415@findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
22416Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
22417
22418@item M-K
22419@kindex M-K (Summary)
22420@findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
22421Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
22422@end table
22423
22424Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
22425
22426@table @kbd
22427
22428@item M-k
22429@kindex M-k (Group)
22430@findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
22431Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
22432
22433@item M-K
22434@kindex M-K (Group)
22435@findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
22436Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
22437@end table
22438
22439Kill file variables:
22440
22441@table @code
22442@item gnus-kill-file-name
22443@vindex gnus-kill-file-name
22444A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
22445@file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
22446this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
22447The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
22448course) is just called @file{KILL}.
22449
22450@vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
22451@item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
22452If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
22453kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
22454kills.
22455
22456@item gnus-apply-kill-hook
22457@vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
22458@findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
22459@findex gnus-apply-kill-file
22460A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
22461@code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
22462kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
22463hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
22464kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
22465
22466@item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
22467@vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
22468A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
22469
22470@end table
22471
22472
22473@node Converting Kill Files
22474@section Converting Kill Files
22475@cindex kill files
22476@cindex converting kill files
22477
22478If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
22479score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
22480the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
22481by hand.
22482
e3e955fe
MB
22483The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
22484You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
22485from
22486@uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
4009494e
GM
22487
22488If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
22489non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
22490hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
22491before.
22492
22493
4009494e
GM
22494@node Advanced Scoring
22495@section Advanced Scoring
22496
22497Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
22498really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
22499about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
22500read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
22501want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
22502
22503By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
22504scoring patterns.
22505
22506@menu
22507* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
22508* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
22509* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
22510@end menu
22511
22512
22513@node Advanced Scoring Syntax
22514@subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
22515
22516Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
22517Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
22518element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
22519non-@code{nil} value.
22520
22521These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
22522operator, and various match operators.
22523
22524Logical operators:
22525
22526@table @code
22527@item &
22528@itemx and
22529This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
22530one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
22531evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
22532@code{true}.
22533
22534@item |
22535@itemx or
22536This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
22537one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
22538then this operator will return @code{false}.
22539
22540@item !
22541@itemx not
22542